blob: e0aa485abb64d3a0edac1512d796e800f6a1a140 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100490 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100491 - tune.lua.session-timeout
492 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100493 - tune.maxaccept
494 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200495 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200496 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100497 - tune.rcvbuf.client
498 - tune.rcvbuf.server
499 - tune.sndbuf.client
500 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100501 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100502 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200503 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100504 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200505 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100506 - tune.zlib.memlevel
507 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509 * Debugging
510 - debug
511 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515------------------------------------
516
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517ca-base <dir>
518 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200519 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
520 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522chroot <jail dir>
523 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
524 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
525 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
526 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
527 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
528 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100529
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100530cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
531 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
532 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
533 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100534 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
535 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
536 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
537 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
538 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
539 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
540 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
541 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
542 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
543 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100544
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200545crt-base <dir>
546 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
547 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
548 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
549
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550daemon
551 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
552 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
553 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
554
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900555external-check
556 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
557 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
558 See "option external-check".
559
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560gid <number>
561 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
562 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
563 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100564 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
565 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200566 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568group <group name>
569 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
570 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200572log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
574 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100575 configured with "log global".
576
577 <address> can be one of:
578
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100579 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100583 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
584 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
585 port).
586
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100587 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
588 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
589 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
590 writeable).
591
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100592 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
593 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
594 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
595 in Bourne shell.
596
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200597 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
598 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
599 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
600 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
601 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
602 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
603 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
604 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
605 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
606 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
607 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
608
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100609 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610
611 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
612 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
613 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
614
615 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200616 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
617 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
618 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
619 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
620 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
621 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200623 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100625log-send-hostname [<string>]
626 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
627 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
628 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
629 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
630 the logs.
631
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000632log-tag <string>
633 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
634 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
635 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100636 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000637
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638lua-load <file>
639 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
640 used multiple times.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642nbproc <number>
643 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
644 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
645 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
646 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
647 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
648
649pidfile <pidfile>
650 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
651 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
652 starting the process. See also "daemon".
653
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100654stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200655 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
656 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
657 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
658 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
659 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
660 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100661 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200662 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
663 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200664
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100665ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
667 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300668 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
670 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
671 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
672 "bind" keyword for more information.
673
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100674ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
676 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
677 keyword to see available options.
678
679 Example:
680 global
681 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
682
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100683ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
685 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300686 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100687 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
688 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
689 information.
690
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100691ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
693 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
694 keyword to see available options.
695
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100696ssl-server-verify [none|required]
697 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
698 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
699 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
700
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200701stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
702 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
703 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
704 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
705 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200706
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200707 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
708 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
709 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200710
711stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
712 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
713 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100714 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200715
716stats maxconn <connections>
717 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
718 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720uid <number>
721 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
722 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
723 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
724 one. See also "gid" and "user".
725
726ulimit-n <number>
727 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
728 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
729 option.
730
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100731unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
732 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
733
734 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
735 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
736 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
737 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
738 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
739 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
740 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
741 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
742 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
743 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
744
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745user <user name>
746 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
747 See also "uid" and "group".
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200749node <name>
750 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
751
752 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
753 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
754 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
755 traffic.
756
757description <text>
758 Add a text that describes the instance.
759
760 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
761 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
762 "<" and ">" characters.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007653.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766-----------------------
767
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200768max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
769 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
770 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
771 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
772 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
773 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
774 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
775 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
776 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778maxconn <number>
779 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
780 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
781 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200782 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
783 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
784 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
785 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100786 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
787 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
788 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
789 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
790 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200792maxconnrate <number>
793 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
794 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
795 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
796 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
797 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
798 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
799 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
800 fairness.
801
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100802maxcomprate <number>
803 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300804 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100805 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
806 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
807 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
808 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
809 default value.
810
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100811maxcompcpuusage <number>
812 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
813 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
814 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
815 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
816 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
817 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
818 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
819 process down and from introducing high latencies.
820
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100821maxpipes <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
823 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
824 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
825 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
826 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
827 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
828
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200829maxsessrate <number>
830 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
831 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
832 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
833 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
834 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
835 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
836 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
837 fairness.
838
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200839maxsslconn <number>
840 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
841 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
842 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
843 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
844 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
845 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
846 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100847 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
848 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
849 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
850 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
851 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
852 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
853 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200854
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200855maxsslrate <number>
856 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
857 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
858 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
859 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
860 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
861 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
862 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
863 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
864 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
865 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
866
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100867maxzlibmem <number>
868 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
869 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
870 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100871 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
872 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
873 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
874
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200875noepoll
876 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
877 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100878 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879
880nokqueue
881 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
882 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
883 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
884
885nopoll
886 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
887 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100888 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100889 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200890
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100891nosplice
892 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
893 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
894 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100895 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100896 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
897 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
898 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
899 "option splice-response".
900
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300901nogetaddrinfo
902 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
903 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
904
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200905spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900906 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
907 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
908 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
909 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
910 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
911 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200912
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100913tune.buffers.limit <number>
914 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
915 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
916 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
917 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
918 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
919 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
920 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
921 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
922 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
923 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
924 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
925 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
926 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
927 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
928 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
929
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100930tune.buffers.reserve <number>
931 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
932 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
933 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
934 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
935
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200936tune.bufsize <number>
937 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
938 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
939 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
940 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
941 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
942 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
943 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
944 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400945 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
946 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
947 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200948
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200949tune.chksize <number>
950 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
951 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
952 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
953 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
954 checks whenever possible.
955
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100956tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
957 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
958 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
959 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
960 this value. The default value is 1.
961
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100962tune.http.cookielen <number>
963 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
964 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
965 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
966 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
967 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
968 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
969 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
970 to change this value.
971
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200972tune.http.maxhdr <number>
973 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
974 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
975 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
976 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
977 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
978 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
979 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
980 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
981 limit too high.
982
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100983tune.idletimer <timeout>
984 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
985 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
986 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
987 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
988 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
989 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
990 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
991 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
992 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
993
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
995 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
996 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
997 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
998 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
999 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1000 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1001 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1002
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001003tune.lua.maxmem
1004 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1005 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1006 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1007 memory.
1008
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001009tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1010 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1011 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1012 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1013 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1014 4s.
1015
1016tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1017 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1018 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1019 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1020 check servers.
1021
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001022tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001023 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1024 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1025 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1026 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1027 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1028 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1029 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1030 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1031 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1032 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001033
1034tune.maxpollevents <number>
1035 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1036 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1037 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1038 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1039 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1040
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001041tune.maxrewrite <number>
1042 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1043 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1044 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1045 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1046 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1047 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1048 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1049 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1050 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1051 bufsize.
1052
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001053tune.pipesize <number>
1054 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1055 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1056 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1057 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1058 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1059 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1060
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001061tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1062tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1063 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1064 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1065 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1066 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1067 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1068 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1069 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1070
1071tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1072tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1073 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1074 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1075 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1076 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1077 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1078 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1079 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1080 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1081 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1082 notifying haproxy again.
1083
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001084tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001085 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1086 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1087 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001088 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001089 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1090 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1091 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1092 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1093 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001094 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1095 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001096
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1098 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1099 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1100 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1101 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1102 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1103 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1104
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001105tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1106 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001107 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001108 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1109 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1110 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1111 being used for too long.
1112
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001113tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1114 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1115 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1116 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1117 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1118 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1119 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1120 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1121 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1122 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1123 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1125 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001126
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001127tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1128 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1129 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1130 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1131 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1132 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1133 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1134 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1135 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1136
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001137tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1138 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001139 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001140 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1141 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1142 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1143
1144tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1145 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1146 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1147 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1148 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011503.3. Debugging
1151--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152
1153debug
1154 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1155 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1156 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1157 system startup.
1158
1159quiet
1160 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1161 line argument "-q".
1162
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011643.4. Userlists
1165--------------
1166It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1167http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1168it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1169
1170userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001171 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001172 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1173
1174group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001175 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001176 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1177 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1178
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001179user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1180 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001181 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1182 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001183 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1184 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001185 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001186 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001187
1188
1189 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001190 userlist L1
1191 group G1 users tiger,scott
1192 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001193
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001194 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1195 user scott insecure-password elgato
1196 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001197
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001198 userlist L2
1199 group G1
1200 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001201
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001202 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1203 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1204 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001205
1206 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001207
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001208
12093.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001210----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001211It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1212haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1213pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1214identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1215or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1216Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1217known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1218the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1219process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1220during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1221tables.
1222
1223peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001224 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1226
1227peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1228 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1229 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1230 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1231 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1232 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1233 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1234
1235 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1236 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1237
1238 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1239 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1240 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1241 across all peers.
1242
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001243 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1244 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1245 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1246
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001247 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001248 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001249 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1250 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1251 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001252
1253 backend mybackend
1254 mode tcp
1255 balance roundrobin
1256 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1257 stick on src
1258
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001259 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1260 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001261
1262
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012633.6. Mailers
1264------------
1265It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1266If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1267in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1268
1269mailer <mailersect>
1270 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1271 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1272
1273mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1274 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1275
1276 Example:
1277 mailers mymailers
1278 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1279 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1280
1281 backend mybackend
1282 mode tcp
1283 balance roundrobin
1284
1285 email-alert mailers mymailers
1286 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1287 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1288
1289 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1290 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1291
1292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001295
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1297 - defaults <name>
1298 - frontend <name>
1299 - backend <name>
1300 - listen <name>
1301
1302A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1303its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1304section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306
1307A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1308connections.
1309
1310A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1311to forward incoming connections.
1312
1313A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1314parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001316All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1317'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1318case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1319
1320Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1321logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1322proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1323However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1324name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1325
1326Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1327and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001328bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001329protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1330modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1331arbitrary criteria.
1332
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001333In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1334a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1335the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1336
1337 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1338 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1339 between responses and new requests.
1340
1341 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1342 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1343 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1344 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1345
1346 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1347 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1348 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1349
1350 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1351 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1352 client-facing connection remains open.
1353
1354 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1355 after the end of the response.
1356
1357The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1358frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1359following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1360weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1361
1362 Backend mode
1363
1364 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1365 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1366 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1367 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1368 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1369 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1370 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1371 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1372 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1373 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1374 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1379--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001381The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1382limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1383they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1384limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001385marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001386option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001387and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1388with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1389specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001390
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001391
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001392 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1393------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1394acl - X X X
1395appsession - - X X
1396backlog X X X -
1397balance X - X X
1398bind - X X -
1399bind-process X X X X
1400block - X X X
1401capture cookie - X X -
1402capture request header - X X -
1403capture response header - X X -
1404clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001405compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001406contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1407cookie X - X X
1408default-server X - X X
1409default_backend X X X -
1410description - X X X
1411disabled X X X X
1412dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001413email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001414email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001415email-alert mailers X X X X
1416email-alert myhostname X X X X
1417email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418enabled X X X X
1419errorfile X X X X
1420errorloc X X X X
1421errorloc302 X X X X
1422-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1423errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001424force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425fullconn X - X X
1426grace X X X X
1427hash-type X - X X
1428http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001429http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001430http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001431http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001432http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001433http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001435ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001436log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001437log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001438log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001439max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440maxconn X X X -
1441mode X X X X
1442monitor fail - X X -
1443monitor-net X X X -
1444monitor-uri X X X -
1445option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1446option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1447option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1448option allbackups (*) X - X X
1449option checkcache (*) X - X X
1450option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1451option contstats (*) X X X -
1452option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1453option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1454option forceclose (*) X X X X
1455-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1456option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001457option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001458option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001459option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001460option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001461option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1463option httpchk X - X X
1464option httpclose (*) X X X X
1465option httplog X X X X
1466option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001467option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001468option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001469option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001470option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1471option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1472option logasap (*) X X X -
1473option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001474option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001475option nolinger (*) X X X X
1476option originalto X X X X
1477option persist (*) X - X X
1478option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001479option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001480option smtpchk X - X X
1481option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1482option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1483option splice-request (*) X X X X
1484option splice-response (*) X X X X
1485option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1486option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1487-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001488option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001489option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1490option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1491option tcpka X X X X
1492option tcplog X X X X
1493option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001494external-check command X - X X
1495external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001496persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1497rate-limit sessions X X X -
1498redirect - X X X
1499redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1500redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1501reqadd - X X X
1502reqallow - X X X
1503reqdel - X X X
1504reqdeny - X X X
1505reqiallow - X X X
1506reqidel - X X X
1507reqideny - X X X
1508reqipass - X X X
1509reqirep - X X X
1510reqisetbe - X X X
1511reqitarpit - X X X
1512reqpass - X X X
1513reqrep - X X X
1514-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1515reqsetbe - X X X
1516reqtarpit - X X X
1517retries X - X X
1518rspadd - X X X
1519rspdel - X X X
1520rspdeny - X X X
1521rspidel - X X X
1522rspideny - X X X
1523rspirep - X X X
1524rsprep - X X X
1525server - - X X
1526source X - X X
1527srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001528stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001529stats auth X - X X
1530stats enable X - X X
1531stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001532stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001533stats realm X - X X
1534stats refresh X - X X
1535stats scope X - X X
1536stats show-desc X - X X
1537stats show-legends X - X X
1538stats show-node X - X X
1539stats uri X - X X
1540-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1541stick match - - X X
1542stick on - - X X
1543stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001544stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001545stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001546tcp-check connect - - X X
1547tcp-check expect - - X X
1548tcp-check send - - X X
1549tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001550tcp-request connection - X X -
1551tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001552tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001553tcp-response content - - X X
1554tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001555timeout check X - X X
1556timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001557timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001558timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1559timeout connect X - X X
1560timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1561timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1562timeout http-request X X X X
1563timeout queue X - X X
1564timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001565timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001566timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1567timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001568timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001569transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001570unique-id-format X X X -
1571unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001572use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001573use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001574------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1575 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1579---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
1581This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1582
1583
1584acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1585 Declare or complete an access list.
1586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1587 no | yes | yes | yes
1588 Example:
1589 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1590 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1591 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001593 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001594
1595
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001596appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1597 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1600 no | no | yes | yes
1601 Arguments :
1602 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1603 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1604
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001605 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 checked in each cookie value.
1607
1608 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1609 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1610 milliseconds.
1611
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001612 request-learn
1613 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1614 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1615 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1616 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1617 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1618 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1619
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001620 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1621 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1622 data following this prefix.
1623
1624 Example :
1625 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1626
1627 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1628 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1629
1630 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1631 2 modes are currently supported :
1632 - path-parameters :
1633 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1634 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1635 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1636 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1637 - query-string :
1638 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1639 query string.
1640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1642 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1643 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1644 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001645 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1646 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1647 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001648 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1649 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1650
1651 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1652
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001653 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1654 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1655 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 Example :
1658 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1659
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001660 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1661 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001662
1663
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001664backlog <conns>
1665 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1667 yes | yes | yes | no
1668 Arguments :
1669 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1670 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001671 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001672
1673 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1674 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1675 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1676 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1677 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1678 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1679 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1680 backlog parameter.
1681
1682 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1683 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1684 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1685
1686 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1687
1688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001689balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001690balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1693 yes | no | yes | yes
1694 Arguments :
1695 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1696 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1697 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1698 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1699
1700 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1701 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1702 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1703 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001704 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001705 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001706 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1707 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1708 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1709 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1710 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1711 it, so that you don't worry.
1712
1713 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1714 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1715 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1716 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1717 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1718 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1719 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1720 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001722 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1723 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1724 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1725 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1726 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1727 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1728 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1729 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1730
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001731 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001732 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001733 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1734 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001735 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001736 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1737 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1738 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1739 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1740 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001741 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1742 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1743 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1744 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1745 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1746 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001747
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1749 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1750 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1751 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1752 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1753 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1754 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1755 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001756 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001758 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1759 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1760 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001762 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1763 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1764 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1765 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1766 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1767 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1768 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1769 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1770 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1771 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1772 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1773 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001775 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001776 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1777 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1778 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1779 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1780 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1781 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1782 URIs start with a leading "/".
1783
1784 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1785 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1786 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1787 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001790 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1791
1792 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001793 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1794 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001795 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1796 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1797 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1798 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001799 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001800 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1801 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001802
1803 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1804 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1805 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1806 server will receive the request.
1807
1808 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1809 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1810 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1811 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1812 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001813 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1814 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1815 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001817 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1818 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1819 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1820 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1821 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001823 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001824 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1825 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1826 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1827
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001828 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1829 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1830 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1831
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001832 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001833 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001834 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1835 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1836 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1837 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1838 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1839 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001840 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001841 used instead.
1842
1843 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1844 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1845 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1846 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1847
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001848 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1849 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1850 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1851
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001852 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001855 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1856 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001857
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001858 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1859 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1860 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
1862 Examples :
1863 balance roundrobin
1864 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001865 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001866 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1867 balance hdr(host)
1868 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001869
1870 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1871 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001873 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001874 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1875 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1876 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1877 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1878
1879 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1880 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1881 defaults to 16 kB.
1882
1883 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1884 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1885
1886 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1887 Round Robin.
1888
1889 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1890 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1891 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1892 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1893
1894 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1895
1896 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001897 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001898 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1899 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1900 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001902 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1903 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001904
1905
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001906bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1907bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001908 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1910 no | yes | yes | no
1911 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001912 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1913 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1914 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1915 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001916 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001917 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1918 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1919 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1920 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1921 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1922 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1923 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001924 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1925 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1926 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1927 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1928 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1929 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1930 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001931 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1932 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1933 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001934 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1935 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1936 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1937 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001938
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001939 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1940 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001941 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1942 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1943 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001944 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1945 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1946 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1947 the range.
1948
1949 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1950 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1951 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1952 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1953 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1954 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1955 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001956 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001957 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001959 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1960 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1961 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1962 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1963 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1964 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1965 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1966 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001968 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1969 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1970 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1971 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1974 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1975 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1976 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1977 in a frontend.
1978
1979 Example :
1980 listen http_proxy
1981 bind :80,:443
1982 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001983 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001985 listen http_https_proxy
1986 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001987 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001988
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001989 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1990 bind ipv6@:80
1991 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1992 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1993
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001994 listen external_bind_app1
1995 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1996
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001997 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001998 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001999
2000
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002001bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002002 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2004 yes | yes | yes | yes
2005 Arguments :
2006 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2007 may be used to override a default value.
2008
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002009 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002010 option may be combined with other numbers.
2011
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002012 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002013 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2014 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2015 missing from all processes.
2016
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002017 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002018 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002019 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2020 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2021 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2022 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002023
2024 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2025 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2026 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2027 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2028 and 'even' instances.
2029
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002030 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2031 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2032 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2033 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002034
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002035 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2036 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2037
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002038 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2039 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2040 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2041
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002042 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2043 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2044
2045 Example :
2046 listen app_ip1
2047 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002048 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002049
2050 listen app_ip2
2051 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002052 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002053
2054 listen management
2055 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002056 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002057
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002058 listen management
2059 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2060 bind-process 1-4
2061
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002062 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002063
2064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065block { if | unless } <condition>
2066 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2068 no | yes | yes | yes
2069
2070 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2071 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002072 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002073 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2075 "block" statements per instance.
2076
2077 Example:
2078 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2079 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2080 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2081 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085
2086capture cookie <name> len <length>
2087 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2089 no | yes | yes | no
2090 Arguments :
2091 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2092 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2093 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2094 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2095 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2096
2097 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2098 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2099 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2100 right if it exceeds <length>.
2101
2102 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2103 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2104 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2105 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2106
2107 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2108 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2109 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2110
2111 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2112 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2113 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002114 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2115 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2116 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117
2118 Example:
2119 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2120
2121 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002122 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123
2124
2125capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002126 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 no | yes | yes | no
2129 Arguments :
2130 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002131 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2133 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2134 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2135
2136 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2137 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2138 it exceeds <length>.
2139
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002140 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2142 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002143 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2144 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2145 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2146 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002147 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002148 environments to find where the request came from.
2149
2150 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2151 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2152 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2153 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002155 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2156 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2157 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2158 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2159 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160
2161 Example:
2162 capture request header Host len 15
2163 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2164 capture request header Referrer len 15
2165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002166 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167 about logging.
2168
2169
2170capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002171 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 no | yes | yes | no
2174 Arguments :
2175 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002176 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2178 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2179 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2180
2181 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2182 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2183 it exceeds <length>.
2184
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002185 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2187 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2188 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002189 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2190 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2191 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2192 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002194 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2195 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2196 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2197 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2198 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199
2200 Example:
2201 capture response header Content-length len 9
2202 capture response header Location len 15
2203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002204 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 about logging.
2206
2207
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002208clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | yes | yes | no
2212 Arguments :
2213 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2215 as explained at the top of this document.
2216
2217 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2218 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2219 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2220 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2221 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2222 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2223 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2224 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002225 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002226 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2227 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2228
2229 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2230 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2231 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2232 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2233 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2234 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2235
2236 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2237 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2238
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002239 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2240 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002242compression algo <algorithm> ...
2243compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002244compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002245 Enable HTTP compression.
2246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2247 yes | yes | yes | yes
2248 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002249 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2250 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2251 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2252
2253 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002254 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002255 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2256 data.
2257
2258 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2259 support for zlib was built in.
2260
2261 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2262 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2263 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2264 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2265 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2266 in.
2267
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002268 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002269 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002270 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2271 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2272 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2273 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2274 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002275
2276 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2277 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2278 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2279 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2280 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002281 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2282 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2283 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2284 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2285 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002286 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2287 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002288
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002289 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002290 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2291 "Accept-Encoding" header
2292 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002293 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002294 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2295 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002296 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2297 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2298 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2299 "multipart"
2300 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2301 header
2302 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2303 and later
2304 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2305 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002306
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002307 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2308 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002309
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002310 Examples :
2311 compression algo gzip
2312 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002314contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2317 yes | no | yes | yes
2318 Arguments :
2319 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2321 as explained at the top of this document.
2322
2323 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002324 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002325 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2327 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2328 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2329 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2330
2331 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2332 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2333 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2334 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2335 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2336 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2337
2338 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2339 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2340 instead.
2341
2342 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2343 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2344
2345
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002346cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002347 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2348 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2351 yes | no | yes | yes
2352 Arguments :
2353 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2354 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2355 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2356 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2357 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2358 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2359 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2360 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2361 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2362
2363 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2364 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2365 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2366 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2367 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2368 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2369 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2370 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2371 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2372 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2373 "insert" and "prefix".
2374
2375 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002376 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002377
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002378 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002379 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2380 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2381 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2382 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2383 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2384 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2385 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2386 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2387 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2388 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
2390 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2391 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2392 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2393 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2394 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2395 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2396 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2397 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2398 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2399 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002400 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2401 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2402 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002404 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2405 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2406 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002407 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2408 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2409 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2410 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002411 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2412 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2413 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
2415 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2416 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2417 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2418 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2419 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2420 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2421 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2422 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2423 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2424
2425 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2426 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2427 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2428 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2429 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2430 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2431 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2432 persistence cookie in the cache.
2433 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2434
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002435 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2436 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2437 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2438 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2439 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2440 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2441 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2442 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2443 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2444 they logout.
2445
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002446 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2447 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2448 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2449 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2450
2451 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2452 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2453 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2454 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2455 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2456 this attribute.
2457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002458 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002459 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002460 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2461 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2462 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2463 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2464 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2465 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002466
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002467 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2468 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2469 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2470 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2471 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2472 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2473 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2474 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2475 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2476 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2477 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2478 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2479 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2480 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2481 the site.
2482
2483 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2484 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2485 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2486 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2487 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2488 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2489 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2490 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2491 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2492 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2493 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2494 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2495 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2496 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2497 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2498 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2501 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2502 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2503 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505 Examples :
2506 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2507 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2508 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002509 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002511 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002512 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002515default-server [param*]
2516 Change default options for a server in a backend
2517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2518 yes | no | yes | yes
2519 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002520 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2521 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2522 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2523 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002524
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002525 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002526 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2527
2528 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002530
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002531default_backend <backend>
2532 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 yes | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
2536 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2537
2538 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2539 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2540 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2541 will catch all undetermined requests.
2542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002543 Example :
2544
2545 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2546 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2547 default_backend dynamic
2548
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002549 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002552description <string>
2553 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2555 no | yes | yes | yes
2556 Arguments : string
2557
2558 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2559 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2560 it describes.
2561 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2562
2563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564disabled
2565 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2567 yes | yes | yes | yes
2568 Arguments : none
2569
2570 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2571 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2572 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2573 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2574 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2575 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2576 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2577
2578 See also : "enabled"
2579
2580
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002581dispatch <address>:<port>
2582 Set a default server address
2583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2584 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002586
2587 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2588 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2589 during start-up.
2590
2591 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2592 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2593 possible with normal servers.
2594
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002595 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002596 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2597 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2598 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2599 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2600
2601 See also : "server"
2602
2603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604enabled
2605 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2607 yes | yes | yes | yes
2608 Arguments : none
2609
2610 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2611 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2612
2613 See also : "disabled"
2614
2615
2616errorfile <code> <file>
2617 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2619 yes | yes | yes | yes
2620 Arguments :
2621 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002622 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
2624 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002625 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002627 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2628 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629
2630 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2631 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2632 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2633
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002634 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2637 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2638 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2639 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2640
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002641 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2642 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2643 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2644 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2645 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2646 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2649 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2650 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002651 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2653
2654 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2655
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002656 Example :
2657 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002658 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002659 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2660 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662
2663errorloc <code> <url>
2664errorloc302 <code> <url>
2665 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2667 yes | yes | yes | yes
2668 Arguments :
2669 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002670 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671
2672 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2673 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2674 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2675 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2676 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2677
2678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2683
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002684 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2685 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2686 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2687 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2688 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2689 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2690 request.
2691
2692 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2693
2694
2695errorloc303 <code> <url>
2696 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2698 yes | yes | yes | yes
2699 Arguments :
2700 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2701 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2702
2703 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2704 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2705 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2706 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2707 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2708
2709 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2710 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2711 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2712
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002713 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002715 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2716 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2717 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2718 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002719 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720
2721 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2722
2723
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002724email-alert from <emailaddr>
2725 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2726 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2727 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2728 yes | yes | yes | yes
2729
2730 Arguments :
2731
2732 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2733
2734 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2735 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2736
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002737 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2738 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2739
2740
2741email-alert level <level>
2742 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2743 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2745 yes | yes | yes | yes
2746
2747 Arguments :
2748
2749 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2750 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2751 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2752
2753 By default level is alert
2754
2755 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2756 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2757 for the proxy.
2758
2759 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2760 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002761 section 3.6 about mailers.
2762
2763
2764email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2765 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2767 yes | yes | yes | yes
2768
2769 Arguments :
2770
2771 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2772
2773 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2774 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2775
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002776 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2777 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002778
2779
2780email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2781 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2782 mailers.
2783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2784 yes | yes | yes | yes
2785
2786 Arguments :
2787
2788 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2789
2790 By default the systems hostname is used.
2791
2792 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2793 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2794 for the proxy.
2795
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002796 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2797 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002798
2799
2800email-alert to <emailaddr>
2801 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2802 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2804 yes | yes | yes | yes
2805
2806 Arguments :
2807
2808 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2809
2810 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2811 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2812
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002813 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002814 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2815
2816
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002817force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2818 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2820 no | yes | yes | yes
2821
2822 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2823 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2824 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2825 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2826 marked down for maintenance operations.
2827
2828 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2829 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2830 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2831 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2832 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2833 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2834 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2835 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2836 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2837
2838 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2839 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2840 is used.
2841
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002842 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002843 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002844
2845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002846fullconn <conns>
2847 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 yes | no | yes | yes
2850 Arguments :
2851 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2852 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2853
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002854 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002855 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002856 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002857 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2858 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2859 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2860 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2861 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002862 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002863
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002864 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2865 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002866 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2867 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2868 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002869
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002870 Example :
2871 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2872 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2873 # connections.
2874 backend dynamic
2875 fullconn 10000
2876 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2877 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2878
2879 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2880
2881
2882grace <time>
2883 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002885 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002886 Arguments :
2887 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2888 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2889 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2890
2891 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2892 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002893 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002894 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2895
2896 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2897 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2898 simplify it.
2899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002901hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002902 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | no | yes | yes
2905 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002906 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2907 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002908
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002909 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2910 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2911 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2912 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2913 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2914 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2915 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2916 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2917 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2918 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002919
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002920 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2921 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2922 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2923 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2924 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2925 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2926 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2927 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2928 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2929 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2930 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2931 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2932 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002933 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2934 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002935
2936 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2937
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002938 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002939 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2940 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2941 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002942 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2943 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2944 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002945
2946 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2947 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002948 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2949 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2950 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2951 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2952
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002953 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2954 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2955 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2956 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2957 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2958 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2959 parameter.
2960
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002961 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2962 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2963 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2964 used on strings.
2965
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002966 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2967
2968 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2969 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2970 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2971 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2972 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2973 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2974 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2975 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2976 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2977 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2978 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2979 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002980
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002981 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2982 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2983 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002984
2985 See also : "balance", "server"
2986
2987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002988http-check disable-on-404
2989 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Arguments : none
2993
2994 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2995 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2996 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2997 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2998 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2999 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3000 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3001 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003002 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3003 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3004 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3005
3006 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3007
3008
3009http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003010 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003013 Arguments :
3014 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3015 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003016 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003017 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3018 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3019 details on the supported keywords.
3020
3021 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3022 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3023 with the usual backslash ('\').
3024
3025 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3026 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3027 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3028 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3029 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3030
3031 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003032 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003033 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3034 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3035 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3036
3037 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003038 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003039 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3040 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3041 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3042 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3043
3044 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003045 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003046 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3047 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3048 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3049 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3050 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3051 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3052 trace).
3053
3054 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003055 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003056 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3057 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3058 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3059 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3060 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3061 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3062
3063 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3064 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3065 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3066 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3067 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3068 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3069 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3070 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3071
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003072 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3073 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3074 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3075
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003076 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3077 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3078
3079 Examples :
3080 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003081 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003082
3083 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003084 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003085
3086 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003087 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003088
3089 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003090 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003091
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003092 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003093
3094
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003095http-check send-state
3096 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3098 yes | no | yes | yes
3099 Arguments : none
3100
3101 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3102 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3103 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3104 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3105 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3106
3107 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3108 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3109 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3110 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3111 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003112 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3113 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3114 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3115
3116 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3117 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3118 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3119
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003120 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3121 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3122 checked in multiple backends.
3123
3124 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3125 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3126
3127 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3128 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3129 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3130 one fails.
3131
3132 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3133 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3134 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3135
3136 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3137 server's queue.
3138
3139 Example of a header received by the application server :
3140 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3141 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3142
3143 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3144
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003145http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003146 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003147 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003148 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3149 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003150 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3151 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003152 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3153 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3154 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003155 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003156 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3157 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003158 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003159 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003160 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3161
3162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 no | yes | yes | yes
3164
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003165 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3166 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3167 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3168 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3169 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003170
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003171 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3172 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3173 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3174
3175 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3176 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3177 are evaluated.
3178
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003179 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3180 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3181 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3182 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3183 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3184 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3185 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3186 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3187 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003188 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003189 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3190
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003191 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3192 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3193 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3194 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3195 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3196
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003197 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3198 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3199 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003200 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3201 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003202
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003203 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3204 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3205 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3206 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3207 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3208 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3209 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3210 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3211
3212 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3213 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3214 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003215 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3216 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003217
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003218 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3219 <name>.
3220
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003221 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3222 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3223 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3224 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3225 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3226 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3227 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3228 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3229
3230 Example:
3231
3232 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3233
3234 applied to:
3235
3236 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3237
3238 outputs:
3239
3240 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3241
3242 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3243
3244 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3245 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3246 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3247 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3248 header.
3249
3250 Example:
3251
3252 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3253
3254 applied to:
3255
3256 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3257
3258 outputs:
3259
3260 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3261
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003262 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3263 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3264 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3265 it.
3266
3267 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3268 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3269 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3270 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3271 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3272 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3273
3274 Example :
3275 # prepend the host name before the path
3276 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3277
3278 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3279 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3280 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3281 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3282 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3283 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3284 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3285 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3286
3287 Example :
3288 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3289 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3290
3291 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3292 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3293 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3294 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3295 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3296 "set-query".
3297
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003298 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3299 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3300 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3301 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3302 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3303 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3304 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3305 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3306
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003307 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3308 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3309 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3310 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3311 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3312 another equipment.
3313
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003314 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3315 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3316 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3317 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3318 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3319 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3320 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3321 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3322
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003323 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3324 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3325 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3326 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3327 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3328 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3329 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3330 admin privileges.
3331
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003332 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3333 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3334 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3335 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3336 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3337 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3338 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3339 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3340
3341 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3342 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3343 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3344 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3345 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3346 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3347
3348 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3349 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3350 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3351 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3352 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3353 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3354
3355 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3356 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3357 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3358 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3359 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3360 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3361 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3362 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3363 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3364
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003365 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3366 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3367 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3368 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3369 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3370 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3371 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3372 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3373 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3374 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3375 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3376 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3377
3378 These actions take one or two arguments :
3379 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3380 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3381 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3382 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3383
3384 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3385 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3386 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3387 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3388
3389 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3390 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3391 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3392 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3393 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3394 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3395 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3396 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3397
3398 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3399 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3400 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3401 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3402 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3403
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003404 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3405 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3406 function is documented in the API documentation.
3407
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003408 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3409
3410 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3411 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3412 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3413 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003414
3415 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003416 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3417 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3418 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003419
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003420 http-request allow if nagios
3421 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3422 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3423 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003424
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003425 Example:
3426 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003427 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003428
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003429 Example:
3430 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3431 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3432 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3433 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3434 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3435 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3436 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3437 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3438 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3439
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003440 Example:
3441 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3442 acl add path /addacl
3443 acl del path /delacl
3444
3445 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3446
3447 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3448 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3449
3450 Example:
3451 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3452 acl setmap path /setmap
3453 acl delmap path /delmap
3454
3455 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3456
3457 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3458 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3459
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003460 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3461 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003462
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003463http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003464 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003465 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3466 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003467 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3468 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3469 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3470 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003471 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3472 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003473 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003474 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003475 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3476
3477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 no | yes | yes | yes
3479
3480 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3481 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3482 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3483 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3484 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3485 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3486
3487 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3488 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3489 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3490 current section.
3491
3492 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3493 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3494 rules are evaluated.
3495
3496 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3497 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3498 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3499 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3500 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3501 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3502 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3503
3504 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3505 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3506 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3507 external users.
3508
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003509 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3510 <name>.
3511
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003512 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3513 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3514 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3515 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3516 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3517 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3518 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3519 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3520
3521 Example:
3522
3523 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3524
3525 applied to:
3526
3527 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3528
3529 outputs:
3530
3531 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3532
3533 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3534
3535 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3536 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3537 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3538 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3539 header.
3540
3541 Example:
3542
3543 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3544
3545 applied to:
3546
3547 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3548
3549 outputs:
3550
3551 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3552
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003553 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3554 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3555 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3556 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3557 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3558 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3559 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3560 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3561
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003562 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3563 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3564 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3565 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3566 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3567 another equipment.
3568
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003569 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3570 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3571 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3572 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3573 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3574 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3575 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3576 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3577
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003578 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3579 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3580 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3581 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3582 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3583 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3584 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3585 admin privileges.
3586
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003587 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3588 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3589 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3590 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3591 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3592 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3593 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3594 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3595
3596 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3597 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3598 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3599 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3600 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3601 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3602
3603 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3604 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3605 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3606 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3607 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3608 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3609
3610 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3611 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3612 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3613 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3614 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3615 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3616 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3617 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3618 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3619
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003620 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3621 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3622 function is documented in the API documentation.
3623
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003624 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3625
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003626 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003627 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3628 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3629 rules.
3630
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003631 Example:
3632 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3633
3634 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3635
3636 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3637 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3638
3639 Example:
3640 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3641
3642 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3643
3644 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3645 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3646
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003647 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3648 ACL usage.
3649
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003650
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003651http-send-name-header [<header>]
3652 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3653
3654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | no | yes | yes
3656
3657 Arguments :
3658
3659 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3660
3661 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3662 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3663 is added with the header string proved.
3664
3665 See also : "server"
3666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003667id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003668 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 no | yes | yes | yes
3671 Arguments : none
3672
3673 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3674 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3675 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003676
3677
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003678ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3679 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3681 no | yes | yes | yes
3682
3683 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3684 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3685 and running).
3686
3687 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3688 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3689 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003690 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003691 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3692
3693 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3694 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3695
3696 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3697 "unless" condition is met.
3698
3699 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3700
3701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003702log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003703log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003704no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003705 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3707 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003708
3709 Prefix :
3710 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3711 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3712 prefix does not allow arguments.
3713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003714 Arguments :
3715 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3716 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3717 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3718 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3719 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3720 parameter.
3721
3722 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3723 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3724
3725 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3726 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3727 standard syslog port).
3728
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003729 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3730 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3731 standard syslog port).
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3734 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3735 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3736 appropriately writeable).
3737
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003738 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3739 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3740 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3741 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3742
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003743 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3744 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3745 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3746 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3747 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3748 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3749 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3750 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3751 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3752 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3753 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003755 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3756
3757 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3758 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3759 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3760
3761 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3762 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3763 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003764 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3765 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3766 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3767 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3768 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3771
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003772 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3773 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3774 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003775
3776 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3777 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3778 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3779 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3780
3781 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3782 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003783
3784 Example :
3785 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003786 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3787 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003788 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3789
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003790
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003791log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003792 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003795
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003796 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3797 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3798 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3799 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3800 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003801
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003802log-tag <string>
3803 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3805 yes | yes | yes | yes
3806
3807 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3808 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3809 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3810 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3811 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3812 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3813 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3814 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3815 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003817max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3818 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | no | yes | yes
3821
3822 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3823 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3824 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3825 servers.
3826
3827 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3828 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3829 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3830 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3831 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3832 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3833 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3834 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3835 picking a different server.
3836
3837 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3838 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3839 even if they have to be queued.
3840
3841 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3842 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3843
3844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003845maxconn <conns>
3846 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 yes | yes | yes | no
3849 Arguments :
3850 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3851 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3852 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3853 closes.
3854
3855 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3856 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3857 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3858 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3859 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3860 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3861 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3862 properly tuned.
3863
3864 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3865 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3866 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3867
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003868 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3869
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003870 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3871
3872
3873mode { tcp|http|health }
3874 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3876 yes | yes | yes | yes
3877 Arguments :
3878 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3879 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3880 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3881 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3882
3883 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3884 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3885 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3886 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3887 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3888
3889 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003890 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3891 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3892 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3893 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3894 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3895 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3896 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003898 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3899 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3900 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003901
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003902 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903 defaults http_instances
3904 mode http
3905
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003906 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003907
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003908
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003909monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003910 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003913 Arguments :
3914 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3915 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003916 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3918 backend and its backup.
3919
3920 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3921 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3922 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3923 servers in a list of backends.
3924
3925 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3926 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3927 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3928 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3929 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3930 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3931 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003932 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3933 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934
3935 Example:
3936 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003937 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003938 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3939 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3940 monitor-uri /site_alive
3941 monitor fail if site_dead
3942
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003943 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003944
3945
3946monitor-net <source>
3947 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3949 yes | yes | yes | no
3950 Arguments :
3951 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3952 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3953 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3954 followed by a mask.
3955
3956 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3957 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003958 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3960
3961 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3962 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3963 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3964 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003965 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3966 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3967 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003968
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003969 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3970 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3971 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3972 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3973 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3974 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003975
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003976 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3977 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003979 Example :
3980 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3981 frontend www
3982 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3983
3984 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3985
3986
3987monitor-uri <uri>
3988 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | yes | yes | no
3991 Arguments :
3992 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3993 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3994
3995 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3996 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3997 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3998 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3999 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4000 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4001 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4002 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4003
4004 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4005 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4006 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4007 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4008 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4009 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4010
4011 Example :
4012 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4013 frontend www
4014 mode http
4015 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4016
4017 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004020option abortonclose
4021no option abortonclose
4022 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments : none
4026
4027 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4028 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4029 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4030 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004031 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004032 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4033 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4034 encountered while delivering the response.
4035
4036 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4037 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4038 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4039 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4040 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4041 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004042 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004043 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004044 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004045 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4046 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4047 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4048
4049 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4050 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4051 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4052 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4053 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4054 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4055 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4056 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004057 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004058
4059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4061
4062 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4063
4064
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004065option accept-invalid-http-request
4066no option accept-invalid-http-request
4067 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | yes | yes | no
4070 Arguments : none
4071
4072 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4073 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4074 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4075 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4076 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4077 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4078 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4079 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004080 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4081 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4082 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4083 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4084 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
4085 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004086
4087 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4088 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4089 been confirmed.
4090
4091 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4092 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004093 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4094 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004095 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4096
4097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4099
4100 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4101 stats socket.
4102
4103
4104option accept-invalid-http-response
4105no option accept-invalid-http-response
4106 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | no | yes | yes
4109 Arguments : none
4110
4111 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4112 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4113 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4114 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4115 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4116 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4117 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4118 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
4119 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
4120
4121 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4122 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4123 been confirmed.
4124
4125 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4126 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4127 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4128 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4129
4130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4132
4133 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4134 stats socket.
4135
4136
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004137option allbackups
4138no option allbackups
4139 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 yes | no | yes | yes
4142 Arguments : none
4143
4144 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4145 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4146 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4147 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4148 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4149 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4150 order between the backup servers anymore.
4151
4152 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4153 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4154
4155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4157
4158
4159option checkcache
4160no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004161 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4163 yes | no | yes | yes
4164 Arguments : none
4165
4166 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4167 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004168 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004169 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4170 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004171 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004172
4173 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004174 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004175 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004176 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4177 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004178 to the client are :
4179 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004180 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004181 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004182 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4183 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4184 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4185 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4186 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4187 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4188 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4189 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4190 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4191 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4192 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4193
4194 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004195 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004196 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004197 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004198 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4199
4200 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4201 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004202 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004203 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4204
4205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4207
4208
4209option clitcpka
4210no option clitcpka
4211 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4213 yes | yes | yes | no
4214 Arguments : none
4215
4216 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4217 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4218 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4219 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4220
4221 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4222 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4223 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4224 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4225
4226 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4227 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4228 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4229 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4230 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4231
4232 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4233
4234 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4235 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4236 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4237
4238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4240
4241 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4242
4243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004244option contstats
4245 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 yes | yes | yes | no
4248 Arguments : none
4249
4250 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4251 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4252 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4253 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4254 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4255 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4256 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4257
4258
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004259option dontlog-normal
4260no option dontlog-normal
4261 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4263 yes | yes | yes | no
4264 Arguments : none
4265
4266 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4267 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4268 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4269 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4270 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4271 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4272 logged.
4273
4274 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4275 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4276 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004278 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004279 logging.
4280
4281
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004282option dontlognull
4283no option dontlognull
4284 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4286 yes | yes | yes | no
4287 Arguments : none
4288
4289 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4290 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4291 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4292 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4293 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4294 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4295 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4296
4297 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4298 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4299 would not be logged.
4300
4301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004304 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004305
4306
4307option forceclose
4308no option forceclose
4309 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004311 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004312 Arguments : none
4313
4314 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4315 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4316 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4317 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4318 global session times in the logs.
4319
4320 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004321 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004322 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004323
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004324 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4325 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4326 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4327
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004328 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4329 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004330
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4333
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004334 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004335
4336
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004337option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004338 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 yes | yes | yes | yes
4341 Arguments :
4342 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4343 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004344 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004345 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004346
4347 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4348 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4349 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4350 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4351 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4352 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4353 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004354 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4355 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4356 possible that the client has already brought one.
4357
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004358 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004359 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004360 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4361 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004362 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4363 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004364
4365 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4366 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4367 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4368 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4369 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4370 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4371 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4372
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004373 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4374 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4375 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4376 are under the control of the end-user.
4377
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004378 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004379 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4380 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004381 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4382 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4383 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004384
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004385 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004386 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4387 frontend www
4388 mode http
4389 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4390
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004391 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4392 backend www
4393 mode http
4394 option forwardfor header X-Client
4395
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004396 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004397 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004398
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004399
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004400option http-keep-alive
4401no option http-keep-alive
4402 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 yes | yes | yes | yes
4405 Arguments : none
4406
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004407 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4408 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4409 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4410 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4411 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4412 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4413 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4414
4415 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4416 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004417 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4418 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4419 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4420 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4421 situations where this option may be useful :
4422
4423 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4424 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4425
4426 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4427 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4428
4429 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4430 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4431 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4432 request.
4433
4434 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4435 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004436 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4437 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4438 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004439
4440 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4441 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4442
4443 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4444 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4445 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4446 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4447 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4448 not set.
4449
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004450 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4451 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004452 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004453 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004454
4455 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004456 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4457 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004458
4459
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004460option http-no-delay
4461no option http-no-delay
4462 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 yes | yes | yes | yes
4465 Arguments : none
4466
4467 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4468 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4469 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4470 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4471 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4472 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4473 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4474 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4475 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4476 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4477 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4478 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4479 affected.
4480
4481 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4482 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4483 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4484 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4485 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4486 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4487 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4488 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4489 latency environments.
4490
4491
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004492option http-pretend-keepalive
4493no option http-pretend-keepalive
4494 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4496 yes | yes | yes | yes
4497 Arguments : none
4498
4499 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4500 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4501 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4502 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4503 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4504 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4505 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4506 consider the response complete.
4507
4508 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4509 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4510 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4511 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4512 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4513 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4514
4515 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4516 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4517 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4518 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4519 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4520 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4521 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4522
4523 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4524 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004525 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004526 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4527 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004528
4529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4531
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004532 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4533 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004534
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004535
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004536option http-server-close
4537no option http-server-close
4538 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4540 yes | yes | yes | yes
4541 Arguments : none
4542
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004543 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4544 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4545 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4546 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4547 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4548 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4549 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4550 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4551 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4552 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4553 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4554 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4555 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4556 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4557 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4558 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004559
4560 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4561 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4562 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4563 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004564 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4565 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004566
4567 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4568 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004569 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4570 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004571 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4572 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004573
4574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4576
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004577 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004578 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4579 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004580
4581
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004582option http-tunnel
4583no option http-tunnel
4584 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | yes | yes | yes
4587 Arguments : none
4588
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004589 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4590 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4591 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4592 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4593 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4594 "option http-tunnel".
4595
4596 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004597 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004598 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4599 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4600 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4601 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4602 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4603 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4604 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004605
4606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4608
4609 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4610 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4611 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4612
4613
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004614option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004615no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004616 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | no
4619 Arguments : none
4620
4621 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4622 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4623 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4624 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4625 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4626 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4627 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4628
4629 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4630 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4631 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4632 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4633 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4634 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4635 request along its whole life.
4636
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004637 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4638 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4639 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4640 front of an existing proxy.
4641
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004642 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4643
4644 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4645 http-server-close".
4646
4647
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004648option httpchk
4649option httpchk <uri>
4650option httpchk <method> <uri>
4651option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4652 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 yes | no | yes | yes
4655 Arguments :
4656 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4657 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4658 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4659 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4660 ones.
4661
4662 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4663 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4664 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4665
4666 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4667 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4668 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4669 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4670 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4671
4672 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4673 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4674 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4675 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4676 the lack of any response.
4677
4678 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4679
4680 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4681 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4682 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4683
4684 Examples :
4685 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4686 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4687 backend https_relay
4688 mode tcp
4689 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4690 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4691
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004692 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4693 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4694 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004695
4696
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004697option httpclose
4698no option httpclose
4699 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments : none
4703
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004704 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4705 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4706 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4707 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004708 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004709 "option http-tunnel".
4710
4711 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4712 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4713 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4714 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4715 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4716 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4717 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4718 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004719
4720 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004721 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004722 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4723 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4724 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4725 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4726 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004727
4728 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4729 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004730 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4731 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004732 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4733 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004734
4735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4737
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004738 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4739 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004740
4741
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004742option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004743 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004746 Arguments :
4747 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4748 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4749 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4750 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4751 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004752
4753 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4754 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4755 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4756 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4757 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4758 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4759 ports.
4760
4761 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4762
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004763 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4764 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004766 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004767
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004768
4769option http_proxy
4770no option http_proxy
4771 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 yes | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4777 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4778 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4779 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4780 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4781
4782 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4783 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4784 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4785 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004786 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004787 be analyzed.
4788
4789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4791
4792 Example :
4793 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4794 backend direct_forward
4795 option httpclose
4796 option http_proxy
4797
4798 See also : "option httpclose"
4799
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004800
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004801option independent-streams
4802no option independent-streams
4803 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments : none
4807
4808 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4809 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4810 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4811 receive data or not.
4812
4813 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4814 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4815 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4816 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4817 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4818 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4819 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4820 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4821 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4822 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4823 socket buffers.
4824
4825 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4826 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4827 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4828 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4829 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4830
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004831 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004832 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4833 deprecated.
4834
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004835 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004836
4837
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004838option ldap-check
4839 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 yes | no | yes | yes
4842 Arguments : none
4843
4844 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4845 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4846 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4847 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4848
4849 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4850 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4851
4852 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4853 configure it.
4854
4855 Example :
4856 option ldap-check
4857
4858 See also : "option httpchk"
4859
4860
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004861option external-check
4862 Use external processes for server health checks
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | no | yes | yes
4865
4866 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4867 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4868 command".
4869
4870 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4871
4872 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4873
4874
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004875option log-health-checks
4876no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004877 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4879 yes | no | yes | yes
4880 Arguments : none
4881
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004882 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4883 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4884 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004885
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004886 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4887 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4888 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4889 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4890 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4891
4892 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4893 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004894
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004895 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4896 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4897 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004898
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004899
4900option log-separate-errors
4901no option log-separate-errors
4902 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | yes | yes | no
4905 Arguments : none
4906
4907 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4908 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4909 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4910 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4911 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4912 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4913 provides very important information.
4914
4915 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4916 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4917 error logs.
4918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004919 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004920 logging.
4921
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004922
4923option logasap
4924no option logasap
4925 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 yes | yes | yes | no
4928 Arguments : none
4929
4930 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4931 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4932 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4933 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4934 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4935 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4936 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004937 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004938 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4939 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4940
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004941 Examples :
4942 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4943 mode http
4944 option httplog
4945 option logasap
4946 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4947
4948 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4949 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4950 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4951 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004953 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004954 logging.
4955
4956
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004957option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004958 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004961 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004962 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4963 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004964 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004965
4966 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4967 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4968 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4969 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4970 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4971 in the MySQL table, like this :
4972
4973 USE mysql;
4974 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4975 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4976
4977 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4978 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4979 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4980 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4981 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4982 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4983 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4984 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4985 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4986
4987 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4988 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004989
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004990 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004991
4992 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4993 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4994 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4995 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4996 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4997 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4998
4999 See also: "option httpchk"
5000
5001
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005002option nolinger
5003no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005004 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005007 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005008
5009 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5010 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5011 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5012 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5013 connections.
5014
5015 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5016 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5017 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5018 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5019 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5020 this too.
5021
5022 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5023 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5024 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5025
5026 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5027 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5028 for servers.
5029
5030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5032
5033
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005034option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5035 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038 Arguments :
5039 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5040 matching <network>
5041 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5042 header name.
5043
5044 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5045 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5046 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5047 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5048 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5049 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5050 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5051 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5052 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5053 possible that the client has already brought one.
5054
5055 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5056 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5057 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5058 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5059 header and requires different one.
5060
5061 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5062 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5063 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5064 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5065 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5066 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5067 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5068
5069 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5070 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5071 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5072 both are defined.
5073
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005074 Examples :
5075 # Original Destination address
5076 frontend www
5077 mode http
5078 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5079
5080 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5081 backend www
5082 mode http
5083 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5084
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005085 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5086 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005087
5088
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005089option persist
5090no option persist
5091 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5093 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005094 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005095
5096 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5097 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5098 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5099 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5100 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5101 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5102 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5103 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5104 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5105 redirected to another valid server.
5106
5107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5109
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005110 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005111
5112
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005113option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5114 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117 Arguments :
5118 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5119 PostgreSQL server.
5120
5121 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5122 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5123 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5124 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5125
5126 See also: "option httpchk"
5127
5128
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005129option prefer-last-server
5130no option prefer-last-server
5131 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | no | yes | yes
5134 Arguments : none
5135
5136 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5137 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5138 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5139 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5140 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5141 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5142 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5143 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5144 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005145 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5146 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5147 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5148 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5149 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5150 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5151 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005152
5153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5155
5156 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5157
5158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005159option redispatch
5160no option redispatch
5161 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005164 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005165
5166 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5167 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5168 be able to access the service anymore.
5169
5170 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5171 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5172
5173 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5174 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5175 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005177 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5178 "redisp" keywords.
5179
5180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5182
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005183 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005184
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005185
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005186option redis-check
5187 Use redis health checks for server testing
5188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5189 yes | no | yes | yes
5190 Arguments : none
5191
5192 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5193 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5194 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5195 find the "+PONG" response message.
5196
5197 Example :
5198 option redis-check
5199
5200 See also : "option httpchk"
5201
5202
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005203option smtpchk
5204option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5205 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005209 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5210 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5211 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5212
5213 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5214 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5215 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5216
5217 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5218 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5219 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5220 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5221 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5222 dead server.
5223
5224 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5225 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5226 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5227 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5228
5229 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5230 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5231 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5232 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5233 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5234
5235 Example :
5236 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5237
5238 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005241option socket-stats
5242no option socket-stats
5243
5244 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5246 yes | yes | yes | no
5247
5248 Arguments : none
5249
5250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005251option splice-auto
5252no option splice-auto
5253 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 yes | yes | yes | yes
5256 Arguments : none
5257
5258 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5259 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5260 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5261 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005262 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005263 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5264 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5265 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5266 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5267
5268 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5269 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5270 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5271 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5272 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5273 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5274 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5275 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5276 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5277 keyword.
5278
5279 Example :
5280 option splice-auto
5281
5282 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5283 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5284
5285 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5286 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5287
5288
5289option splice-request
5290no option splice-request
5291 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | yes | yes | yes
5294 Arguments : none
5295
5296 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005297 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005298 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5299 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5300 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5301 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5302
5303 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5304
5305 Example :
5306 option splice-request
5307
5308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5310
5311 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5312 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5313
5314
5315option splice-response
5316no option splice-response
5317 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | yes | yes | yes
5320 Arguments : none
5321
5322 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005323 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005324 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5325 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5326 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5327 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5328
5329 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5330
5331 Example :
5332 option splice-response
5333
5334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5336
5337 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5338 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5339
5340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005341option srvtcpka
5342no option srvtcpka
5343 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | no | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : none
5347
5348 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5349 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5350 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5351 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5352
5353 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5354 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5355 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5356 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5357
5358 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5359 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5360 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5361 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5362 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5363
5364 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5365
5366 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5367 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5368 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5369
5370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5372
5373 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5374
5375
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005376option ssl-hello-chk
5377 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 yes | no | yes | yes
5380 Arguments : none
5381
5382 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5383 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5384 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5385 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5386 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5387 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5388 hello message.
5389
5390 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5391 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5392 messages, which is appreciable.
5393
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005394 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5395 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5396 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005397
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005398 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5399
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005400
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005401option tcp-check
5402 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 yes | no | yes | yes
5405
5406 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5407 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5408
5409 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5410 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5411 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5412
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005413 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005414 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5415 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5416 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5417 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5418 only.
5419
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005420 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005421 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5422 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5423 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5424 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5425
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005426 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005427 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5428 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005429 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005430 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5431 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5432 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5433 the respective protocols.
5434 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5435 analysed.
5436
5437 Examples :
5438 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5439 option tcp-check
5440 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5441
5442 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5443 option tcp-check
5444 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5445
5446 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5447 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005448 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005449 option tcp-check
5450 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5451 tcp-check expect +PONG
5452 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5453 tcp-check expect string role:master
5454 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5455 tcp-check expect string +OK
5456
5457 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5458 (send many headers before analyzing)
5459 option tcp-check
5460 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5461 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5462 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5463 tcp-check send \r\n
5464 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5465
5466
5467 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5468
5469
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005470option tcp-smart-accept
5471no option tcp-smart-accept
5472 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5474 yes | yes | yes | no
5475 Arguments : none
5476
5477 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5478 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5479 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5480 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5481 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5482 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5483
5484 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5485 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5486 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5487 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5488
5489 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5490 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5491 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5492 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5493
5494 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5495 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5496 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5497
5498 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5499 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5500 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5501
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005502 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5503
5504
5505option tcp-smart-connect
5506no option tcp-smart-connect
5507 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5509 yes | no | yes | yes
5510 Arguments : none
5511
5512 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5513 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5514 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5515 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5516 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5517
5518 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5519 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5520 complex.
5521
5522 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5523 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5524 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5525
5526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5528
5529 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5530
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005532option tcpka
5533 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | yes | yes | yes
5536 Arguments : none
5537
5538 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5539 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5540 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5541 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5542
5543 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5544 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5545 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5546 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5547
5548 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5549 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5550 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5551 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5552 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5553
5554 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5555
5556 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5557 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5558 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5559 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5560 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5561 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5562 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5563 backends.
5564
5565 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5566
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005567
5568option tcplog
5569 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | yes | yes | yes
5572 Arguments : none
5573
5574 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5575 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5576 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5577 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5578 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5579 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5580 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5581 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5582
5583 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005585 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005586
5587
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005588option transparent
5589no option transparent
5590 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005592 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005593 Arguments : none
5594
5595 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5596 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5597 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5598 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5599 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5600 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5601 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5602 appropriate server.
5603
5604 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5605 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5606
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005607 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005608 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005609
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005610
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005611external-check command <command>
5612 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5614 yes | no | yes | yes
5615
5616 Arguments :
5617 <command> is the external command to run
5618
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005619 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5620
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005621 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005622
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005623 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5624 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5625 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5626 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5627 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5628 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005629
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005630 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5631
5632 Environment variables :
5633 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5634 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5635
5636 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5637
5638 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5639
5640 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5641 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5642 for a UNIX socket).
5643
5644 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5645
5646 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5647
5648 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5649
5650 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5651
5652 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5653
5654 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5655 socket).
5656
5657 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5658 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5659
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005660 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5661 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5662 failed.
5663
5664 Example :
5665 external-check command /bin/true
5666
5667 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5668
5669
5670external-check path <path>
5671 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | no | yes | yes
5674
5675 Arguments :
5676 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5677
5678 The default path is "".
5679
5680 Example :
5681 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5682
5683 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5684 "external-check command"
5685
5686
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005687persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005688persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005689 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
5693 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005694 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5695 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005696
5697 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5698 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5699 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5700 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5701 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5702 forwarded to this server.
5703
5704 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5705 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5706 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005707 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005708 a single "listen" section.
5709
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005710 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5711 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5712 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5713
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005714 Example :
5715 listen tse-farm
5716 bind :3389
5717 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5718 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5719 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5720 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5721 persist rdp-cookie
5722 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005723 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005724 balance rdp-cookie
5725 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5726 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5727
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005728 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5729 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005730
5731
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005732rate-limit sessions <rate>
5733 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | yes | yes | no
5736 Arguments :
5737 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5738 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5739
5740 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5741 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5742 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5743 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5744 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5745 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5746
5747 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5748 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5749 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5750 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5751
5752 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5753 listen smtp
5754 mode tcp
5755 bind :25
5756 rate-limit sessions 10
5757 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5758
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005759 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5760 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5761 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005762
5763 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5764
5765
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005766redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5767redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5768redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005769 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5771 no | yes | yes | yes
5772
5773 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005774 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005775
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005776 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005777 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005778 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5779 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5780 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005781
5782 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5783 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5784 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5785 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5786 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005787 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5788 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5789 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5790 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005791
5792 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5793 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5794 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5795 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5796 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5797 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005798 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005799 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005800 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5801 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5802 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005803
5804 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005805 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5806 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5807 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5808 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5809 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5810 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5811 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5812 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005813
5814 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5815 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5816
5817 - "drop-query"
5818 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5819 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5820 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5821 with a location-type redirect.
5822
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005823 - "append-slash"
5824 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5825 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5826 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5827 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5828
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005829 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5830 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5831 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5832 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5833 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5834 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5835 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5836
5837 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5838 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5839 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5840 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5841 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5842 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5843 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005844
5845 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5846 acl clear dst_port 80
5847 acl secure dst_port 8080
5848 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005849 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005850 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005851 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5852
5853 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005854 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5855 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5856 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005857 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005858
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005859 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5860 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5861 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5862
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005863 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005864 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005865
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005866 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5867 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5868 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005870 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005871
5872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005873redisp (deprecated)
5874redispatch (deprecated)
5875 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005878 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005879
5880 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5881 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5882 be able to access the service anymore.
5883
5884 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5885 redistribute them to a working server.
5886
5887 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5888 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5889 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005891 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5892 "option redispatch" instead.
5893
5894 See also : "option redispatch"
5895
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005896
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005897reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005898 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 no | yes | yes | yes
5901 Arguments :
5902 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5903 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005904 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005905
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005906 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5907 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5908
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005909 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5910 the last header of an HTTP request.
5911
5912 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5913 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5914 responses.
5915
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005916 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5917 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5918 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5919
5920 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5921 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005922
5923
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005924reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5925reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005926 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 no | yes | yes | yes
5929 Arguments :
5930 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5931 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5932 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5933 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5934 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5935 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5936 ignores case.
5937
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005938 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5939 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5940
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005941 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5942 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5943 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5944 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005945 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005946
5947 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5948 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5949
5950 Example :
5951 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5952 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5953 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5954
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005955 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5956 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005957
5958
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005959reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5960reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005961 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 no | yes | yes | yes
5964 Arguments :
5965 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5966 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5967 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5968 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5969 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5970 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5971
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005972 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5973 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5974
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005975 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5976 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5977 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5978 next servers.
5979
5980 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5981 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5982 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5983
5984 Example :
5985 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5986 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5987 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5988
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005989 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5990 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005991
5992
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005993reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5994reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005995 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5997 no | yes | yes | yes
5998 Arguments :
5999 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6000 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6001 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6002 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6003 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6004 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6005 case.
6006
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006007 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6008 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6009
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006010 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6011 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6012 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6013 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006014 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006015
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006016 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006017 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006018 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006019
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006020 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6021 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6022
6023 Example :
6024 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6025 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6026 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6027
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006028 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6029 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006030
6031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006032reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6033reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006034 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6036 no | yes | yes | yes
6037 Arguments :
6038 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6039 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6040 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6041 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6042 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6043 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6044 case.
6045
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006046 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6047 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6048
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006049 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6050 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6051 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6052 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6053
6054 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6055 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6056
6057 Example :
6058 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6059 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6060 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6061 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6062
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006063 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6064 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006065
6066
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006067reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6068reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006069 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6071 no | yes | yes | yes
6072 Arguments :
6073 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6074 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6075 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6076 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6077 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6078 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6079
6080 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6081 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6082 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6083 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006084 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006085
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006086 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6087 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6088
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006089 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6090 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6091 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6092
6093 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6094 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6095 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6096 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6097 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6098
6099 Example :
6100 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006101 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006102 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6103 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6104
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006105 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6106 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006107
6108
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006109reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6110reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006111 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6113 no | yes | yes | yes
6114 Arguments :
6115 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6116 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6117 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6118 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6119 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6120 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6121 ignores case.
6122
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006123 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6124 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6125
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006126 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6127 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006128 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6129 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6130 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006131 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6132 not set.
6133
6134 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6135 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6136 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6137 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6138 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6139
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006140 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006141 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6142 # block all others.
6143 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6144 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6145
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006146 # block bad guys
6147 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6148 reqitarpit . if badguys
6149
6150 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6151 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006152
6153
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006154retries <value>
6155 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
6158 Arguments :
6159 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6160 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6161 default value is 3.
6162
6163 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6164 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6165 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6166
6167 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6168 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6169
6170 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6171 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6172
6173 See also : "option redispatch"
6174
6175
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006176rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006177 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 no | yes | yes | yes
6180 Arguments :
6181 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6182 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006183 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006184
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006185 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6186 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6187
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006188 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6189 the last header of an HTTP response.
6190
6191 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6192 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6193 responses.
6194
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006195 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6196 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006197
6198
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006199rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6200rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006201 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6203 no | yes | yes | yes
6204 Arguments :
6205 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6206 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6207 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6208 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6209 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6210 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6211 ignores case.
6212
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006213 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6214 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6215
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006216 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6217 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006218 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006219 client.
6220
6221 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6222 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6223 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6224
6225 Example :
6226 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006227 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006228
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006229 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6230 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006231
6232
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006233rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6234rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006235 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6237 no | yes | yes | yes
6238 Arguments :
6239 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6240 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6241 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6242 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6243 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6244 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6245 ignores case.
6246
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006247 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6248 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6249
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006250 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6251 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6252 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6253 case-sensitive.
6254
6255 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006256 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6257 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6258 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006259
6260 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6261 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6262
6263 Example :
6264 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6265 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6266
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006267 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6268 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006269
6270
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006271rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6272rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006273 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6275 no | yes | yes | yes
6276 Arguments :
6277 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6278 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6279 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6280 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6281 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6282 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6283 ignores case.
6284
6285 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6286 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6287 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6288 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006289 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006290
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006291 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6292 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6293
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006294 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6295 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6296 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6297
6298 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6299 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6300 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6301 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6302 are not case-sensitive.
6303
6304 Example :
6305 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6306 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6307
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006308 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6309 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006310
6311
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006312server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006313 Declare a server in a backend
6314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6315 no | no | yes | yes
6316 Arguments :
6317 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006318 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006319 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006320
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006321 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6322 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6323 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6324 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006325 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6326 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6327 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6328 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6329 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006330 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6331 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6332 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6333 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6334 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6335 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6336 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006337 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006338 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6339 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6340 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6341 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006342
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006343 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006344 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6345 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6346 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6347 adding this value to the client's port.
6348
6349 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6350 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006351 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006352
6353 Examples :
6354 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6355 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006356 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006357 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6358 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6359 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006360
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006361 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6362 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006363
6364
6365source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006366source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006367source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006368 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6370 yes | no | yes | yes
6371 Arguments :
6372 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6373 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006374
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006375 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006376 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6377 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6378 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6379 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6380 supported prefixes are :
6381 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6382 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6383 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006384 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006385 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6386 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6387 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6388 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006389
6390 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6391 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006392 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6393 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6394 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006395
6396 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6397 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6398 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6399 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6400 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6401 <addr>.
6402
6403 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6404 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6405 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6406 port.
6407
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006408 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6409 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6410 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6411 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006412 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006413 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6414 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6415 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6416 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6417 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6418 HTTP header.
6419
6420 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6421 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006422 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006423 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6424 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6425 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6426 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6427 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6428 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6429 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6430
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006431 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6432 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6433 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6434 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6435 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6436 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6437
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006438 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6439 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6440 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6441 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6442
6443 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6444 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6445 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6446 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6447 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6448 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6449
6450 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6451 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6452 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6453 there are two methods :
6454
6455 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6456 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6457 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6458 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6459 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6460 of the client ranges may be used.
6461
6462 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6463 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6464 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6465 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6466 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6467 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6468 same session.
6469
6470 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6471 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6472 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6473 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6474 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6475 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6476
6477 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6478 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6479 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006480 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006481
6482 Examples :
6483 backend private
6484 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6485 source 192.168.1.200
6486
6487 backend transparent_ssl1
6488 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6489 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6490
6491 backend transparent_ssl2
6492 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6493 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6494 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6495
6496 backend transparent_ssl3
6497 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6498 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6499 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6500
6501 backend transparent_smtp
6502 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6503 # with Tproxy version 4.
6504 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6505
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006506 backend transparent_http
6507 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6508 # proxy.
6509 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006511 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006512 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006514
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006515srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6516 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6518 yes | no | yes | yes
6519 Arguments :
6520 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6521 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6522 as explained at the top of this document.
6523
6524 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6525 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6526 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6527 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6528 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6529 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6530 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6531
6532 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6533 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6534 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6535 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6536 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006537 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006538 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006539 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006540
6541 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6542 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6543 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6544 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6545 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6546 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6547
6548 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6549 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6550
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006551 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6552 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006553
6554
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006555stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6556 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006558 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006559
6560 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6561 matched.
6562
6563 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6564 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6565
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006566 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6567 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6568 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6569
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006570 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6571 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6572 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6573 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006574
6575 Example :
6576 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6577 backend stats_localhost
6578 stats enable
6579 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6580
6581 Example :
6582 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6583 backend stats_auth
6584 stats enable
6585 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6586 stats admin if TRUE
6587
6588 Example :
6589 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6590 userlist stats-auth
6591 group admin users admin
6592 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6593 group readonly users haproxy
6594 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6595
6596 backend stats_auth
6597 stats enable
6598 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6599 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6600 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6601 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6602
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006603 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6604 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6605 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006606
6607
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006608stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6609 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006611 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006612 Arguments :
6613 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6614
6615 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6616
6617 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6618 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6619 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6620 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6621 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6622 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6623
6624 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6625 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6626 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006627 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006628
6629 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6630 report using "stats scope".
6631
6632 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6633 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6634 unobvious parameters.
6635
6636 Example :
6637 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6638 backend public_www
6639 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6640 stats enable
6641 stats hide-version
6642 stats scope .
6643 stats uri /admin?stats
6644 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6645 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6646 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6647
6648 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6649 backend private_monitoring
6650 stats enable
6651 stats uri /admin?stats
6652 stats refresh 5s
6653
6654 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6655
6656
6657stats enable
6658 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006660 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006661 Arguments : none
6662
6663 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6664 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6665 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6666 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6667 - stats auth : no authentication
6668 - stats scope : no restriction
6669
6670 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6671 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6672 unobvious parameters.
6673
6674 Example :
6675 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6676 backend public_www
6677 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6678 stats enable
6679 stats hide-version
6680 stats scope .
6681 stats uri /admin?stats
6682 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6683 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6684 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6685
6686 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6687 backend private_monitoring
6688 stats enable
6689 stats uri /admin?stats
6690 stats refresh 5s
6691
6692 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6693
6694
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006695stats hide-version
6696 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006698 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006699 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006700
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006701 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6702 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6703 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6704 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6705 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6706 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006708 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6709 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6710 unobvious parameters.
6711
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006712 Example :
6713 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6714 backend public_www
6715 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006716 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006717 stats hide-version
6718 stats scope .
6719 stats uri /admin?stats
6720 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6721 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6722 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006723
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006724 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6725 backend private_monitoring
6726 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006727 stats uri /admin?stats
6728 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006730 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006731
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006732
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006733stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6735 Access control for statistics
6736
6737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6738 no | no | yes | yes
6739
6740 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6741 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6742 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6743 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6744 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6745 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6746
6747 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6748 instance.
6749
6750 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6751 about ACL usage.
6752
6753
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006754stats realm <realm>
6755 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006757 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006758 Arguments :
6759 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6760 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6761 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6762
6763 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6764 using a backslash ('\').
6765
6766 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6767 only related to authentication.
6768
6769 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6770 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6771 unobvious parameters.
6772
6773 Example :
6774 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6775 backend public_www
6776 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6777 stats enable
6778 stats hide-version
6779 stats scope .
6780 stats uri /admin?stats
6781 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6782 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6783 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6784
6785 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6786 backend private_monitoring
6787 stats enable
6788 stats uri /admin?stats
6789 stats refresh 5s
6790
6791 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6792
6793
6794stats refresh <delay>
6795 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006797 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006798 Arguments :
6799 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6800 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6801 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6802 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6803 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6804 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6805
6806 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6807 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6808 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6809 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6810
6811 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6812 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6813 unobvious parameters.
6814
6815 Example :
6816 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6817 backend public_www
6818 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6819 stats enable
6820 stats hide-version
6821 stats scope .
6822 stats uri /admin?stats
6823 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6824 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6825 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6826
6827 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6828 backend private_monitoring
6829 stats enable
6830 stats uri /admin?stats
6831 stats refresh 5s
6832
6833 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6834
6835
6836stats scope { <name> | "." }
6837 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006840 Arguments :
6841 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6842 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6843 section in which the statement appears.
6844
6845 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6846 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6847 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6848 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6849 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6850 exists.
6851
6852 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6853 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6854 unobvious parameters.
6855
6856 Example :
6857 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6858 backend public_www
6859 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6860 stats enable
6861 stats hide-version
6862 stats scope .
6863 stats uri /admin?stats
6864 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6865 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6866 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6867
6868 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6869 backend private_monitoring
6870 stats enable
6871 stats uri /admin?stats
6872 stats refresh 5s
6873
6874 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6875
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006876
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006877stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006878 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006880 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006881
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006882 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006883 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6884
6885 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6886 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6887
6888 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6889 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006890 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006891
6892 Example :
6893 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6894 backend private_monitoring
6895 stats enable
6896 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6897 stats uri /admin?stats
6898 stats refresh 5s
6899
6900 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6901 global section.
6902
6903
6904stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006905 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6907 yes | yes | yes | yes
6908 Arguments : none
6909
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006910 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006911 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6912 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6913 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6914 - IP (socket, server)
6915 - cookie (backend, server)
6916
6917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006919 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006920
6921 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6922
6923
6924stats show-node [ <name> ]
6925 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006928 Arguments:
6929 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6930 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6931
6932 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6933 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006934 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006935
6936 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6937 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6938 unobvious parameters.
6939
6940 Example:
6941 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6942 backend private_monitoring
6943 stats enable
6944 stats show-node Europe-1
6945 stats uri /admin?stats
6946 stats refresh 5s
6947
6948 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6949 section.
6950
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006951
6952stats uri <prefix>
6953 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006955 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006956 Arguments :
6957 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6958 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6959 query string.
6960
6961 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6962 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6963 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6964 possible to reach it in the application.
6965
6966 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006967 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006968 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6969 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6970 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6971 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6972
6973 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6974 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6975 an address or a port to statistics only.
6976
6977 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6978 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6979 unobvious parameters.
6980
6981 Example :
6982 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6983 backend public_www
6984 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6985 stats enable
6986 stats hide-version
6987 stats scope .
6988 stats uri /admin?stats
6989 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6990 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6991 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6992
6993 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6994 backend private_monitoring
6995 stats enable
6996 stats uri /admin?stats
6997 stats refresh 5s
6998
6999 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7000
7001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007002stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7003 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007005 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007006
7007 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007008 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007009 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7010 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7011 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7012
7013 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7014 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7015 the "stick-table" statement.
7016
7017 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7018 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7019 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7020 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7021 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7022
7023 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7024 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7025 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7026 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7027 transformation rules.
7028
7029 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7030 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7031 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7032 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7033 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7034 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7035 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7036
7037 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7038 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7039 ACL based conditions.
7040
7041 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7042 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7043 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7044 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7045
7046 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7047 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7048 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7049 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7050
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007051 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7052 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7053 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7054
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007055 Example :
7056 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7057 # last 30 minutes
7058 backend pop
7059 mode tcp
7060 balance roundrobin
7061 stick store-request src
7062 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7063 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7064 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7065
7066 backend smtp
7067 mode tcp
7068 balance roundrobin
7069 stick match src table pop
7070 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7071 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7072
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007073 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007074 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007075
7076
7077stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7078 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7080 no | no | yes | yes
7081
7082 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7083 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7084 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7085 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7086
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007087 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7088 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7089 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7090
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007091 Examples :
7092 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007093 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007094
7095 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7096 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7097 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7098
7099
7100 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7101 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7102 backend http
7103 mode http
7104 balance roundrobin
7105 stick on src table https
7106 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7107 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7108 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7109
7110 backend https
7111 mode tcp
7112 balance roundrobin
7113 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7114 stick on src
7115 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7116 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7117
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007118 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007119
7120
7121stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7122 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7124 no | no | yes | yes
7125
7126 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007127 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007128 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7129 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7130 server is selected.
7131
7132 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7133 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7134 the "stick-table" statement.
7135
7136 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7137 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7138 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7139 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7140 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7141 address.
7142
7143 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7144 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7145 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7146 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7147 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7148 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7149 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7150 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7151 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7152 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7153
7154 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7155 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7156 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7157 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7158 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7159 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7160 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7161
7162 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7163 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7164 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7165 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7166
7167 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7168 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7169 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7170 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7171 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7172 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007173 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7174 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7175 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7176 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7177 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7178 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007179
7180 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7181 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7182 the request.
7183
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007184 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7185 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7186 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7187
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007188 Example :
7189 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7190 # last 30 minutes
7191 backend pop
7192 mode tcp
7193 balance roundrobin
7194 stick store-request src
7195 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7196 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7197 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7198
7199 backend smtp
7200 mode tcp
7201 balance roundrobin
7202 stick match src table pop
7203 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7204 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7205
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007206 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007207 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007208
7209
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007210stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007211 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7212 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007213 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007215 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007216
7217 Arguments :
7218 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7219 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7220 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7221 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7222
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007223 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7224 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7225 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7226 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7227
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007228 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7229 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7230 instance.
7231
7232 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7233 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7234 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7235 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7236 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7237 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007238 to 32 characters.
7239
7240 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7241 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7242 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007243 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007244 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7245 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007246
7247 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007248 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7249 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007250 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7251 increase.
7252
7253 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007254 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7255 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7256 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007257
7258 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7259 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7260 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7261 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7262 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7263 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7264 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7265 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7266 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7267 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7268 parameter (see below).
7269
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007270 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7271 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7272 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7273 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7274 soft restart.
7275
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007276 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7277
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007278 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7279 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7280 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7281 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7282 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007283 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007284 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7285 if not expiration delay is specified.
7286
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007287 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7288 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7289 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7290 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007291 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7292 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7293 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7294 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7295 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7296 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7297 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7298 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7299 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7300 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7301 types and their arguments.
7302
7303 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7304 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7305 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7306 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7307
7308 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7309 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7310 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7311 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7312
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007313 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7314 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7315 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7316 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7317 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7318 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7319
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007320 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7321 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7322 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7323 they were received.
7324
7325 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7326 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7327 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7328 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7329 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7330
7331 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7332 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7333 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7334 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7335 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7336
7337 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7338 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7339 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7340
7341 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7342 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7343 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7344 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7345 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7346
7347 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7348 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7349 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7350 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7351 the client side.
7352
7353 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7354 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7355 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7356 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7357 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7358 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7359 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7360
7361 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7362 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7363 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7364 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7365 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7366 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7367 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7368
7369 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7370 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7371 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7372 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7373 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7374 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7375
7376 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7377 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7378 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7379 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7380
7381 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7382 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7383 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7384 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7385 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7386 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7387 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7388 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7389 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7390 recommended for better fairness.
7391
7392 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7393 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7394 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7395 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7396
7397 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7398 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7399 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7400 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7401 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7402 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7403 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7404 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7405 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7406 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007407
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007408 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7409 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007410 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7411 reference it.
7412
7413 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7414 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7415 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7416 as an exclusive stickiness.
7417
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007418 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7419 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7420 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7421 something that can be ignored.
7422
7423 Example:
7424 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7425 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7426 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7427 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7428
7429 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007430 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007431
7432
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007433stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7434 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 no | no | yes | yes
7437
7438 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007439 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007440 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7441 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7442 server is selected.
7443
7444 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7445 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7446 the "stick-table" statement.
7447
7448 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7449 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7450 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7451 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7452
7453 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7454 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7455 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7456 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7457 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7458 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007459 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007460 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7461 rules.
7462
7463 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7464 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7465 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7466 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7467 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7468 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7469 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7470
7471 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7472 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7473 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7474 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7475
7476 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7477 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7478 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7479 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7480 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7481 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007482 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7483 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7484 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7485 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7486 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7487 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7488 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7489 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7490 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007491
7492 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7493
7494 Example :
7495 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7496 backend https
7497 mode tcp
7498 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007499 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007500 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007501
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007502 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7503 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7504
7505 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7506 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7507 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7508
7509 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7510 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007511
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007512 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7513 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7514 # at offset 44.
7515
7516 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7517 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7518
7519 # Learn on response if server hello.
7520 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007521
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007522 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7523 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7524
7525 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7526 extraction.
7527
7528
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007529tcp-check connect [params*]
7530 Opens a new connection
7531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7532 no | no | yes | yes
7533
7534 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7535 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7536 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7537
7538 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7539 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7540 of the sequence.
7541
7542 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7543 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7544 do.
7545
7546 Parameters :
7547 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7548 use the TCP connection.
7549
7550 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7551 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7552 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7553
7554 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7555
7556 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7557
7558 Examples:
7559 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7560 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7561 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7562 option tcp-check
7563 tcp-check connect
7564 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7565 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7566 tcp-check send \r\n
7567 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7568 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7569 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7570 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7571 tcp-check send \r\n
7572 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7573 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7574
7575 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7576 option tcp-check
7577 tcp-check connect port 110
7578 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7579 tcp-check connect port 143
7580 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7581 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7582
7583 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7584
7585
7586tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7587 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7588 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 no | no | yes | yes
7590
7591 Arguments :
7592 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7593 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7594 binary.
7595 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7596 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7597 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7598
7599 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7600 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7601 with the usual backslash ('\').
7602 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7603 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7604 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7605 used upper or lower case.
7606
7607
7608 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7609
7610 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7611 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7612 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7613 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7614 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7615 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7616 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7617 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7618
7619 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7620 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7621 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7622 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7623 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7624 expression.
7625
7626 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7627 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7628 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7629 this exact hexadecimal string.
7630 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7631
7632 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7633 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7634 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7635 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7636 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7637 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7638 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7639 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7640 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7641 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7642 the null character.
7643
7644 Examples :
7645 # perform a POP check
7646 option tcp-check
7647 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7648
7649 # perform an IMAP check
7650 option tcp-check
7651 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7652
7653 # look for the redis master server
7654 option tcp-check
7655 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7656 tcp-check expect +PONG
7657 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7658 tcp-check expect string role:master
7659 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7660 tcp-check expect string +OK
7661
7662
7663 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7664 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7665
7666
7667tcp-check send <data>
7668 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7670 no | no | yes | yes
7671
7672 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7673 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7674
7675 Examples :
7676 # look for the redis master server
7677 option tcp-check
7678 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7679 tcp-check expect string role:master
7680
7681 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7682 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7683
7684
7685tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7686 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7687 tcp health check
7688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7689 no | no | yes | yes
7690
7691 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7692 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7693 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7694 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7695 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7696 hexadecimal string.
7697 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7698
7699 Examples :
7700 # redis check in binary
7701 option tcp-check
7702 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7703 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7704
7705
7706 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7707 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7708
7709
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007710tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7711 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7713 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007714 Arguments :
7715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007716 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7717 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007719 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007720
7721 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7722 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007723 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7724 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7725 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7726 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7727 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7728 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007730 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7731 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7732 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7733 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007734
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007735 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007736 - accept :
7737 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7738 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7739 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007740
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007741 - reject :
7742 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7743 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7744 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7745 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7746 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7747 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7748 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7749 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7750 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7751 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7752 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7753 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007754
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007755 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7756 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7757 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7758 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7759 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7760 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7761 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7762 hosts.
7763
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007764 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7765 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7766 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7767 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7768 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7769 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7770 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7771 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7772 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7773 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7774 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7775
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007776 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007777 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007778 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007779 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007780 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7781 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007782 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007783 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7784 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7785 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7786 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7787 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007788
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007789 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007790 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007791 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007792 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7793 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7794 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7795 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007797 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7798 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7799 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7800 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007802 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7803 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7804 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7805 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7806 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007807 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7808 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7809 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7810 layer7 information is extracted.
7811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007812 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7813 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7814 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7815 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7816 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007818 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7819 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7820 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007821
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007822 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7823 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7824 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007826 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007827 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007828 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007830 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7831 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7832 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007834 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007835 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7836 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007837
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007838 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7839
7840 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7841
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007842 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007844 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007845
7846
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007847tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7848 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007850 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007851 Arguments :
7852 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007853 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007854 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7855 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007857 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007858
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007859 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7860 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7861 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7862 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7863 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007865 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7866 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7867 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7868 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007869 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7870 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7871 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7872 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7873 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7874 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007875 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007876 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007877
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007878 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7879 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7880 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7881 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007882
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007883 Four types of actions are supported :
7884 - accept : the request is accepted
7885 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7886 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007887 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007889 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7890 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007891
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007892 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7893 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7894 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7895 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7896 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7897 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007899 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007900 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7901 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007903 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007904 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7905 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7906 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7907 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007908 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7909 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7910 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007911
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007912 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007913 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7914 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7915 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007916
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007917 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
7918 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
7919 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
7920 documentation.
7921
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007922 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007923 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7924 # and reject everything else.
7925 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7926 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007927 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007928 tcp-request content reject
7929
7930 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007931 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7932 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7933 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007934 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007935
7936 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7937 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7938 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007939 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007940 tcp-request content reject
7941
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007942 Example:
7943 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7944 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007945 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007946
7947 Example:
7948 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7949 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007950 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007952 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7953 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7954
7955 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007956 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007957 # protecting all our sites
7958 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007959 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7960 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007961 ...
7962 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7963
7964 backend http_dynamic
7965 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007966 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007967 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007968 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7969 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7970 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007971 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007973 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007975 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007976
7977
7978tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7979 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007981 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007982 Arguments :
7983 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7984 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7985 as explained at the top of this document.
7986
7987 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7988 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7989 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7990 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7991 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7992
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007993 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7994 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7995 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7996 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7997
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007998 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7999 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008000 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008001 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008002 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8003 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8004 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8005 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008006
8007 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8008 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8009 it pass through unaffected.
8010
8011 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8012 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8013 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008014 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008015 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8016 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008017 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8018 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8019 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008020
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008021 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008022 "timeout client".
8023
8024
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008025tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8026 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 no | no | yes | yes
8029 Arguments :
8030 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008031 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008032
8033 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8034
8035 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8036 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8037 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008038 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8039 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008040
8041 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8042
8043 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8044 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8045 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8046 inserted.
8047
8048 Two types of actions are supported :
8049 - accept :
8050 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8051 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8052 the rules evaluation.
8053
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008054 - close :
8055 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8056 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8057 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8058 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8059 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8060 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008061 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008062 protocols.
8063
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008064 - reject :
8065 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8066 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008067 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008068
8069 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8070 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8071 for changing the default action to a reject.
8072
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008073 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8074 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8075 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8076 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008077 period.
8078
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008079 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8080 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8081 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8082 documentation.
8083
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008084 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8085
8086 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8087
8088
8089tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8090 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 no | no | yes | yes
8093 Arguments :
8094 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8095 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8096 as explained at the top of this document.
8097
8098 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8099
8100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008101timeout check <timeout>
8102 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8103 established.
8104
8105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 yes | no | yes | yes
8107 Arguments:
8108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8110 as explained at the top of this document.
8111
8112 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8113 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8114 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8115 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008116 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8117 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8118 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008119
8120 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8121 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8122
8123 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8124 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008125 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008126
8127 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8128 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8129 forget about it.
8130
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008131 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8132 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008133
8134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008135timeout client <timeout>
8136timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8137 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | yes | yes | no
8140 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008141 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008142 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8143 as explained at the top of this document.
8144
8145 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8146 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8147 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8148 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8149 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8150 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8151 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8152 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008153 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008154 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008155 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8156 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008157 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8158 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008159
8160 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8161 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8162 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8163 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8164 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8165 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8166
8167 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8168 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8169 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8170
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008171 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008172
8173
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008174timeout client-fin <timeout>
8175 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8177 yes | yes | yes | no
8178 Arguments :
8179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8181 as explained at the top of this document.
8182
8183 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8184 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8185 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8186 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8187 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8188 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8189 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8190 down in one direction.
8191
8192 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8193 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8194 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8195
8196 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8197
8198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008199timeout connect <timeout>
8200timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8201 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8203 yes | no | yes | yes
8204 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008205 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008206 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8207 as explained at the top of this document.
8208
8209 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008210 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008211 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008212 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008213 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8214 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008215
8216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8222
8223 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8224 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8225 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8226
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008227 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8228 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008229
8230
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008231timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8232 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | yes | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
8236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8238 as explained at the top of this document.
8239
8240 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8241 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8242 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8243 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8244 once the request has started to present itself.
8245
8246 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8247 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8248 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8249 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8250 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8251
8252 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8253 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8254 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8255 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8256
8257 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8258 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8259 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8260 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8261 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008262 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008263
8264 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8265 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8266 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8267 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8268
8269 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8270
8271
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008272timeout http-request <timeout>
8273 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008275 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008276 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8279 as explained at the top of this document.
8280
8281 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8282 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8283 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8284 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8285 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8286 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8287 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008288 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8289 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8290 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8291 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8292 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8293 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8294 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008295
8296 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8297 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008298 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8299 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008300
8301 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8302 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8303 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8304 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8305 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8306
8307 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008308 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8309 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8310 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008311
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008312 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008313
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008314
8315timeout queue <timeout>
8316 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8318 yes | no | yes | yes
8319 Arguments :
8320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8322 as explained at the top of this document.
8323
8324 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8325 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8326 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8327 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8328 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8329
8330 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8331 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8332 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8333 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8334
8335 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8336
8337
8338timeout server <timeout>
8339timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8340 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8342 yes | no | yes | yes
8343 Arguments :
8344 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8345 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8346 as explained at the top of this document.
8347
8348 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8349 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8350 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8351 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8352 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8353 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8354 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8355
8356 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8357 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8358 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8359 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8360 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008361 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008362 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008363 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8364 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8365 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8366 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008367
8368 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8369 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8370 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8371 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8372 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8373 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8374
8375 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8376 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8377 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8378
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008379 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008380
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008381
8382timeout server-fin <timeout>
8383 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | no | yes | yes
8386 Arguments :
8387 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8388 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8389 as explained at the top of this document.
8390
8391 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8392 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8393 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8394 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8395 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8396 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8397 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8398 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8399 situations, it should not be needed.
8400
8401 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8402 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8403 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8404
8405 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8406
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008407
8408timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008409 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8411 yes | yes | yes | yes
8412 Arguments :
8413 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8414 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8415 as explained at the top of this document.
8416
8417 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8418 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8419 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8420
8421 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8422 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8423 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8424 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008425 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008426
8427 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8428
8429
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008430timeout tunnel <timeout>
8431 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments :
8435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8437 as explained at the top of this document.
8438
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008439 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008440 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8441 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8442 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8443 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8444 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8445 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8446 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8447 specified.
8448
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008449 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8450 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8451 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8452 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8453 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8454 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8455 state.
8456
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008457 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8458 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8459 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8460 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8461 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8462
8463 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8464 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8465 forget about it.
8466
8467 Example :
8468 defaults http
8469 option http-server-close
8470 timeout connect 5s
8471 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008472 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008473 timeout server 30s
8474 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8475
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008476 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008477
8478
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008479transparent (deprecated)
8480 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008482 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008483 Arguments : none
8484
8485 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8486 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8487 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8488 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8489 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8490 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8491 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8492 appropriate server.
8493
8494 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8495
8496 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8497 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8498
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008499 See also: "option transparent"
8500
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008501unique-id-format <string>
8502 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8504 yes | yes | yes | no
8505 Arguments :
8506 <string> is a log-format string.
8507
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008508 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8509 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8510 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8511 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008512
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008513 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8514 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8515 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8516 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8517 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8518 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8519 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8520 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008521
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008522 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8523 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008524
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008525 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008526
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008527 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008528
8529 will generate:
8530
8531 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8532
8533 See also: "unique-id-header"
8534
8535unique-id-header <name>
8536 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | yes | yes | no
8539 Arguments :
8540 <name> is the name of the header.
8541
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008542 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8543 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008544
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008545 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008546
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008547 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008548 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8549
8550 will generate:
8551
8552 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8553
8554 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008555
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008556use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008557 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8559 no | yes | yes | no
8560 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008561 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8562 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008563
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008564 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8565 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008566
8567 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8568 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8569 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008570 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8571 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8572 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8573 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008574
8575 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8576 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8577 assign the backend.
8578
8579 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8580 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8581 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8582 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8583 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8584 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8585
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008586 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008587 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008588 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8589 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8590 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8591
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008592 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8593 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8594 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8595 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8596 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8597 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8598 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8599 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8600 cannot be forced from the request.
8601
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008602 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008603 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8604 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8605
8606 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8607 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008608
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008609
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008610use-server <server> if <condition>
8611use-server <server> unless <condition>
8612 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8614 no | no | yes | yes
8615 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008616 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008617
8618 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8619
8620 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8621 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8622 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8623
8624 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8625 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8626 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8627 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8628 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8629 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8630 matches will assign the server.
8631
8632 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8633 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8634 with the next rules until one matches.
8635
8636 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8637 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8638 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8639 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8640
8641 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8642 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8643 stripped.
8644
8645 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8646 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8647 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8648 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8649
8650 Example :
8651 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8652 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8653 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8654 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8655 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8656 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8657 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8658 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8659 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8660
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008661 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008662
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008663
86645. Bind and Server options
8665--------------------------
8666
8667The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8668depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8669settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8670written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8671described in this section.
8672
8673
86745.1. Bind options
8675-----------------
8676
8677The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8678as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8679no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8680parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8681while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8682provided immediately after the setting name.
8683
8684The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8685
8686accept-proxy
8687 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008688 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8689 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008690 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8691 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8692 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8693 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8694 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8695 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8696 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008697 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8698 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008699
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008700alpn <protocols>
8701 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8702 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8703 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8704 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8705 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8706 initial NPN extension.
8707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008708backlog <backlog>
8709 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8710 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8711
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008712ecdhe <named curve>
8713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008714 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8715 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008716
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008717ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8719 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8720 client's certificate.
8721
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008722ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8724 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8725 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8726 error is ignored.
8727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008728ciphers <ciphers>
8729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8730 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008731 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008732 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8733 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8734
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008735crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008736 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8737 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8738 to verify client's certificate.
8739
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008740crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8742 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8743 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8744 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8745 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8746 file.
8747
8748 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8749 are loaded.
8750
8751 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008752 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008753 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8754 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8755 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8756 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8757 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8758 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8759 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008760
8761 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8762 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8763 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8764 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008765 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8766 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008767
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008768 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008769
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008770 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8771 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008772 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008773 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8774 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8775 clients).
8776
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008777 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8778 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8779 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8780 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8781 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8782 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8783 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8784 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8785 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8786 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8787 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8788 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8789 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8790
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008791 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8792 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
8793 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
8794 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
8795 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
8796
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008797crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8799 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008800 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008801 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008802
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008803crt-list <file>
8804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008805 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8806 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008807
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008808 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008809
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008810 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8811 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8812 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8813 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8814 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8815 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8816 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8817 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008819defer-accept
8820 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8821 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8822 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8823 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8824 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8825 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8826 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8827 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8828 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8829 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8830 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8831
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008832force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008833 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008834 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008835 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8836 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008837
8838force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008839 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008840 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8841 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008842
8843force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008844 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008845 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8846 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008847
8848force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008849 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008850 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8851 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008853gid <gid>
8854 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8855 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8856 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8857 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8858 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8859
8860group <group>
8861 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8862 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8863 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8864 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8865 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8866
8867id <id>
8868 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8869 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8870 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8871 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8872
8873interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008874 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8875 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8876 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8877 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8878 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8879 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8880 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008881
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008882level <level>
8883 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8884 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8885 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8886 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8887 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8888 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8889 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8890 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8891 counters).
8892 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8893 all counters).
8894
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008895maxconn <maxconn>
8896 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8897 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8898 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8899 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8900 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8901 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8902 eat all memory.
8903
8904mode <mode>
8905 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8906 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8907 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8908 UNIX sockets.
8909
8910mss <maxseg>
8911 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8912 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8913 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8914 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8915 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8916 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8917 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8918 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8919 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8920 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8921 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8922
8923name <name>
8924 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8925 page.
8926
8927nice <nice>
8928 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8929 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8930 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8931 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8932 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8933 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8934 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8935 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8936 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8937 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8938 one for an RDP socket.
8939
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008940no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008942 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008943 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008944 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8945 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008946 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008947
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008948no-tls-tickets
8949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8950 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8951 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008952 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8953 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008954
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008955no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008957 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008958 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008959 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8960 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8961 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008963no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008965 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008966 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008967 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8968 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8969 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008970
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008971no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008973 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008974 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008975 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8976 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8977 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008978
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008979npn <protocols>
8980 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8981 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8982 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8983 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008984 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8985 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008986
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008987process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8988 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8989 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8990 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8991 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8992 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8993 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8994 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008995 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8996 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8997 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8998 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8999 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9000 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9001 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009003ssl
9004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009005 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009006 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9007 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9008 to deciphered contents.
9009
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009010strict-sni
9011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9012 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9013 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9014 See the "crt" option for more information.
9015
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009016tcp-ut <delay>
9017 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9018 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9019 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9020 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9021 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9022 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9023 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9024 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9025 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9026 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9027 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9028
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009029tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009030 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009031 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9032 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9033 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9034 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9035 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9036 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9037 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009038 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9039 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9040 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009041
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009042tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9043 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9044 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9045 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9046 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9047 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9048 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9049 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9050 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9051 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9052 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9053
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009054transparent
9055 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9056 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9057 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9058 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9059 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9060 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9061 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9062 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9063 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9064 so check for support with your vendor.
9065
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009066v4v6
9067 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9068 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9069 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9070 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009071 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009072
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009073v6only
9074 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9075 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9076 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009077 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9078 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009079
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009080uid <uid>
9081 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9082 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9083 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9084 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9085 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9086
9087user <user>
9088 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9089 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9090 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9091 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9092 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9093
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009094verify [none|optional|required]
9095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9096 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9097 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9098 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9099 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009100 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9101 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9102 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9103 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009104
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020091055.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009106------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009108The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9109which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9110arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9111settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9112after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9113Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9114address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009116 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009117 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009119The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009120
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009121addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009122 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9123 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9124 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9125 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9126 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009128 Supported in default-server: No
9129
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009130agent-check
9131 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009132 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9133 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9134 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9135 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009136
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009137 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009138 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009139 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9140 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9141 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009142
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009143 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9144 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009145
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009146 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9147 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9148 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009149
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009150 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9151 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9152 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009153
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009154 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9155 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9156 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9157 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9158 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9159 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9160 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009161
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009162 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9163 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009164
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009165 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9166 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9167 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9168 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9169 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9170 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9171 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9172 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9173 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009174
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009175 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9176 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009177 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9178 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9179 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9180 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009181
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009182 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9183 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009184
9185 Supported in default-server: No
9186
9187agent-inter <delay>
9188 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9189 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9190
9191 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9192 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9193 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9194 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9195 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9196 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9197 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9198 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9199 of backends use the same servers.
9200
9201 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9202
9203 Supported in default-server: Yes
9204
9205agent-port <port>
9206 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9207
9208 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9209
9210 Supported in default-server: Yes
9211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009212backup
9213 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9214 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9215 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9216 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9217 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9218 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009220 Supported in default-server: No
9221
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009222ca-file <cafile>
9223 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9224 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9225 server's certificate.
9226
9227 Supported in default-server: No
9228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009229check
9230 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009231 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9232 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9233 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9234 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9235 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9236 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9237 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009238 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9239 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9240 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009242 Supported in default-server: No
9243
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009244check-send-proxy
9245 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9246 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9247 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9248 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9249 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9250 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9251 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9252
9253 Supported in default-server: No
9254
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009255check-ssl
9256 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9257 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9258 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9259 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009260 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009261 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9262 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9263 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9264 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9265
9266 Supported in default-server: No
9267
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009268ciphers <ciphers>
9269 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009270 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009271 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9272 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9273 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9274 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9275 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9276 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9277
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009278 Supported in default-server: No
9279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009280cookie <value>
9281 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9282 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9283 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9284 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9285 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9286 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9287 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009289 Supported in default-server: No
9290
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009291crl-file <crlfile>
9292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9293 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9294 to verify server's certificate.
9295
9296 Supported in default-server: No
9297
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009298crt <cert>
9299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9300 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9301 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9302 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9303 certificate request.
9304
9305 Supported in default-server: No
9306
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009307disabled
9308 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9309 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9310 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9311 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9312 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9313
9314 Supported in default-server: No
9315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009316error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009317 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9318 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9319 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009321 Supported in default-server: Yes
9322
9323 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009325fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009326 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9327 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9328 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009330 Supported in default-server: Yes
9331
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009332force-sslv3
9333 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9334 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009335 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9336 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009337
9338 Supported in default-server: No
9339
9340force-tlsv10
9341 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009342 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9343 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009344
9345 Supported in default-server: No
9346
9347force-tlsv11
9348 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009349 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9350 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009351
9352 Supported in default-server: No
9353
9354force-tlsv12
9355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009356 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9357 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009358
9359 Supported in default-server: No
9360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009361id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009362 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9363 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9364 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009366 Supported in default-server: No
9367
9368inter <delay>
9369fastinter <delay>
9370downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009371 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9372 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9373 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9374 between checks depending on the server state :
9375
9376 Server state | Interval used
9377 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9378 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9379 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9380 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9381 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9382 or yet unchecked. |
9383 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9384 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9385 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009387 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9388 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9389 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9390 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009391 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9392 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9393 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9394 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9395 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009397 Supported in default-server: Yes
9398
9399maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009400 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9401 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9402 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9403 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9404 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9405 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9406 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9407 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009409 Supported in default-server: Yes
9410
9411maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009412 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9413 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9414 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9415 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9416 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9417 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9418 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009420 Supported in default-server: Yes
9421
9422minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009423 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9424 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9425 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9426 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9427 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9428 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009429 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009430 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009432 Supported in default-server: Yes
9433
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009434no-ssl-reuse
9435 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9436 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9437 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9438 and for paranoid users.
9439
9440 Supported in default-server: No
9441
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009442no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009443 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9444 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009445 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009446
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009447 Supported in default-server: No
9448
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009449no-tls-tickets
9450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9451 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9452 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009453 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9454 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009455
9456 Supported in default-server: No
9457
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009458no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009459 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009460 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9461 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009462 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9463 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9464 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009465
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009466 Supported in default-server: No
9467
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009468no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009469 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009470 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9471 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009472 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9473 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9474 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009475
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009476 Supported in default-server: No
9477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009478no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009479 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009480 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9481 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009482 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9483 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9484 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009485
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009486 Supported in default-server: No
9487
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009488non-stick
9489 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9490 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9491 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9492
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009493 Supported in default-server: No
9494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009495observe <mode>
9496 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9497 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9498 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9499 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9500 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9501 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009502 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009504 Supported in default-server: No
9505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009506 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009508on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009509 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9510 Currently, four modes are available:
9511 - fastinter: force fastinter
9512 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9513 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9514 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9515 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009517 Supported in default-server: Yes
9518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009519 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9520
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009521on-marked-down <action>
9522 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9523 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009524 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9525 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9526 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9527 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9528 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9529 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9530 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9531 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009532
9533 Actions are disabled by default
9534
9535 Supported in default-server: Yes
9536
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009537on-marked-up <action>
9538 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9539 Currently one action is available:
9540 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9541 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9542 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9543 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9544 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9545 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9546 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9547 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9548
9549 Actions are disabled by default
9550
9551 Supported in default-server: Yes
9552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009553port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009554 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9555 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9556 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9557 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9558 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9559 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009561 Supported in default-server: Yes
9562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563redir <prefix>
9564 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9565 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9566 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9567 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9568 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9569 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9570 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9571 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009572 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009573 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9574 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9575 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9576 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9577 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9578
9579 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009581 Supported in default-server: No
9582
9583rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009584 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9585 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9586 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009588 Supported in default-server: Yes
9589
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009590send-proxy
9591 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9592 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9593 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9594 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9595 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9596 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9597 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9598 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9599 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009600 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9601 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9602 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9603 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9604 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009605
9606 Supported in default-server: No
9607
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009608send-proxy-v2
9609 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9610 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9611 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9612 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9613 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9614 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9615 option of the "bind" keyword.
9616
9617 Supported in default-server: No
9618
9619send-proxy-v2-ssl
9620 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9621 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9622 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9623 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9624 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9625 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9626 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9627 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9628
9629 Supported in default-server: No
9630
9631send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9632 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9633 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9634 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9635 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9636 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9637 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9638 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9639 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9640 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9641
9642 Supported in default-server: No
9643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009644slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009645 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9646 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9647 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9648 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9649 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9650 parameters :
9651
9652 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9653 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9654
9655 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9656 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9657 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9658 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9659
9660 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9661 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9662 seen as failed.
9663
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009664 Supported in default-server: Yes
9665
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009666source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009667source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009668source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009669 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9670 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9671 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9672 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9673
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009674 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9675 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9676 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9677 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9678 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9679 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9680 server.
9681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009682 Supported in default-server: No
9683
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009684ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009685 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9686 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9687 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9688 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9689 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9690 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009691 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009692
9693 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009695track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009696 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9697 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9698 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9699 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009700 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009702 Supported in default-server: No
9703
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009704verify [none|required]
9705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009706 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9707 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9708 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9709 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009710 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9711 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9712 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009713
9714 Supported in default-server: No
9715
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009716verifyhost <hostname>
9717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9718 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9719 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9720 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9721 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9722 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9723
9724 Supported in default-server: No
9725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009726weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009727 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9728 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9729 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009730 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9731 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9732 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9733 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9734 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9735 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009737 Supported in default-server: Yes
9738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009739
97406. HTTP header manipulation
9741---------------------------
9742
9743In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9744response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9745request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9746which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009747against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009748
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009749If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9750to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9751but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9752HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9753stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9754because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9755a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9756still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009758This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9759in section 4.2 :
9760
9761 - reqadd <string>
9762 - reqallow <search>
9763 - reqiallow <search>
9764 - reqdel <search>
9765 - reqidel <search>
9766 - reqdeny <search>
9767 - reqideny <search>
9768 - reqpass <search>
9769 - reqipass <search>
9770 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9771 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9772 - reqtarpit <search>
9773 - reqitarpit <search>
9774 - rspadd <string>
9775 - rspdel <search>
9776 - rspidel <search>
9777 - rspdeny <search>
9778 - rspideny <search>
9779 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9780 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9781
9782With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9783is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9784parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9785prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9786Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9787
9788 \t for a tab
9789 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9790 \n for a new line (LF)
9791 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9792 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9793 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9794 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9795 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9796
9797The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9798portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9799above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9800regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
98019 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9802is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9803
9804The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9805after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9806
9807Notes related to these keywords :
9808---------------------------------
9809 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9810 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9811 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9812
9813 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9814 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9815 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9816
9817 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9818 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9819 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9820 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9821 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9822
9823 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9824 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9825 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9826 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9827 useless headers before adding new ones.
9828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009829 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009830 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9831
9832 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9833 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9834 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9835
9836 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9837 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009838 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009839
9840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098417. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9842----------------------------------
9843
9844Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9845client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9846The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9847these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9848but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9849data called patterns.
9850
9851
98527.1. ACL basics
9853---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009854
9855The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9856content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9857from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9858simple :
9859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009860 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009861 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009862 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9863 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9866adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009867
9868In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009870 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009871
9872This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9873Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9874and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009875an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9876conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9877as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9878are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009879
9880ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9881'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9882which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9883
9884There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9885performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009887The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9888specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9889this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009890methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9891ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009892
9893Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9894 - boolean
9895 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9896 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9897 - string
9898 - data block
9899
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009900Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9901converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9902would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9903The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9904which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9905
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009906Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9907keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9908fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9909which are summarized in the table below :
9910
9911 +---------------------+-----------------+
9912 | Sample or converter | Default |
9913 | output type | matching method |
9914 +---------------------+-----------------+
9915 | boolean | bool |
9916 +---------------------+-----------------+
9917 | integer | int |
9918 +---------------------+-----------------+
9919 | ip | ip |
9920 +---------------------+-----------------+
9921 | string | str |
9922 +---------------------+-----------------+
9923 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9924 +---------------------+-----------------+
9925
9926Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9927matching method, see below.
9928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009929The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9930 - boolean
9931 - integer or integer range
9932 - IP address / network
9933 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9934 - regular expression
9935 - hex block
9936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009937The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9938
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009939 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9940 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009941 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009942 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009943 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009944 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009945 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009947The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9948read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9949if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9950lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9951will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9952beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9953a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9954lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9955exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9956
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009957The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9958parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9959ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9960a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9961check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9962
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009963The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9964socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9965file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9968loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9969
9970 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9971
9972In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9973the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9974case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9975as well.
9976
9977The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9978sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9979do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9980methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9981is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9982obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9983followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9984default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9985that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9986string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9987
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009988The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9989By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9990string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9991resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9992server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9993waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9994flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9995function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009997There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9998sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9999be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010000
10001 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10002 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10004 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10005 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10006 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010007
10008 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10009 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010011
10012 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010014
10015 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010017
10018 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10019 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10020
10021 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10022 binary or string samples.
10023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10025 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10028 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10029 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010031 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10032 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10035 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010037 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10038 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10041 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010042 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10045 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10046 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010047
10048For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10049request, it is possible to do :
10050
10051 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10052
10053In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10054buffer, one would use the following acl :
10055
10056 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10057
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010058On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10059possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10060
10061 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010063All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10064criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10065method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10066to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10067criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10068the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010070If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010071the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10072For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10075 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10076 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10077 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010078
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010079
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010080The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10081types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10082combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10083brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10084default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010086 +-------------------------------------------------+
10087 | Input sample type |
10088 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010089 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010090 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10091 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10092 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010093 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010095 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010096 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010097 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010098 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010099 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010100 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010101 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010103 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010104 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010105 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010106 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010107 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010109 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010110 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010111 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010113 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010114 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10115 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10116 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010117
10118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101197.1.1. Matching booleans
10120------------------------
10121
10122In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10123Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10124When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10125that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10126
10127Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10128return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10129"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101327.1.2. Matching integers
10133------------------------
10134
10135Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10136enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10137to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10138
10139Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10140matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10141lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010142
10143For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10144unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10145representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10146
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010147As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10148two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10149instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10150ranges and operators.
10151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010152For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010153operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10154Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10155of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010157Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010158
10159 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10160 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10161 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10162 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10163 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010165For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010166
10167 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10168
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010169This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10170
10171 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10172
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101747.1.3. Matching strings
10175-----------------------
10176
10177String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10178different forms :
10179
10180 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10181 patterns ;
10182
10183 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10184 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10185
10186 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10187 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10188
10189 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10190 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10191
10192 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10193 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10194 matches.
10195
10196 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10197 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10198 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010199
10200String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10201exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10202characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10203string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10204to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010205before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010206
10207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102087.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10209---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010210
10211Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10212they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10213possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10214passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10215the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010216the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10217match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010218
10219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102207.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10221-------------------------------------
10222
10223It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10224not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10225a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10226to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10227digits may be used upper or lower case.
10228
10229Example :
10230 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10231 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10232
10233
102347.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10235---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010236
10237IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10238netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10239within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010240host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010241difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10242at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10243does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10244parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010245
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010246IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10247Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10248trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10249IPv6 patterns.
10250
10251HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10252following situations :
10253 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10254 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10255 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10256 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10257 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10258 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10259 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10260 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10261 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10262 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264
102657.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10266----------------------------------
10267
10268Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10269combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10270
10271 - AND (implicit)
10272 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10273 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010275A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010277 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10280indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10283"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10284requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10285is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10286
10287 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10288 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10289 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10290 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10291
10292To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10293and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10294
10295 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10296 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10297 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10298 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10299
10300 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10301 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10302 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10303 use_backend www if host_www
10304
10305It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10306expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10307be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10308the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10309
10310 The following rule :
10311
10312 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10313 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10314
10315 Can also be written that way :
10316
10317 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10318
10319It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10320to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10321simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10322sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10323good use is the following :
10324
10325 With named ACLs :
10326
10327 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10328 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10329 monitor fail if site_dead
10330
10331 With anonymous ACLs :
10332
10333 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10334
10335See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10336
10337
103387.3. Fetching samples
10339---------------------
10340
10341Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10342against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10343sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10344ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10345of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10346available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10347
10348This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10349Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10350compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10351deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10352
10353The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10354matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10355method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10356indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10357
10358As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10359when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10360mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10361the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10362ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10363
10364Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10365multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10366when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10367incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10368are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10369is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10370all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10371
10372Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10373 - name
10374 - name(arg1)
10375 - name(arg1,arg2)
10376
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010377
103787.3.1. Converters
10379-----------------
10380
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010381Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10382of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10383is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10384was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10385has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10386unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10387
10388These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10389sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10390the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10391support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010393A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10394support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10395supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10396(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10397bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010401add(<value>)
10402 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10403 result as an unsigned integer.
10404
10405and(<value>)
10406 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10407 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10408
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010409base64
10410 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10411 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10412 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10413
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010414bool
10415 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10416 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10417 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10418 presence of a flag).
10419
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010420bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10421 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10422 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10423 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10424
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010425cpl
10426 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10427 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10428
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010429crc32([<avalanche>])
10430 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10431 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10432 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10433 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10434 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10435 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10436 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10437 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10438 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10439 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10440 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10441
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010442div(<value>)
10443 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10444 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10445 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10446
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010447djb2([<avalanche>])
10448 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10449 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10450 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10451 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10452 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10453 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10454 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010455 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10456 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010458even
10459 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10460 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10461
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010462field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10463 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10464 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10465 list of chars.
10466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010467hex
10468 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10469 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10470 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10471 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010473http_date([<offset>])
10474 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10475 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10476 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10477 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10478 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10479 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010480
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010481in_table(<table>)
10482 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10483 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10484 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10485 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10486 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10487
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010488ipmask(<mask>)
10489 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10490 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10491 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10492 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10493
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010494json([<input-code>])
10495 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10496 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10497 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10498 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10499 of errors:
10500 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10501 bytes, ...)
10502 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10503 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10504
10505 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10506 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10507 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10508 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10509 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10510 are :
10511 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10512 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10513 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10514 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10515 error ;
10516 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10517 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10518
10519 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10520 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10521
10522 Example:
10523 capture request header user-agent len 150
10524 capture request header Host len 15
10525 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10526
10527 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10528 GET / HTTP/1.0
10529 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10530
10531 Output log:
10532 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010534language(<value>[,<default>])
10535 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10536 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10537 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10538 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10539 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10540 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10541 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10542 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10543 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10544 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10545 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10546 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010548 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010550 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10551 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010552
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010553 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10554 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10555 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10556 use_backend spanish if es
10557 use_backend french if fr
10558 use_backend english if en
10559 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010560
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010561lower
10562 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10563 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10564 type. The result is of type string.
10565
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010566ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10567 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10568 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10569 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10570 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10571 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10572 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10573
10574 Example :
10575
10576 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10577 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10578 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010580map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10581map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10582map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10583 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10584 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10585 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10586 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10587 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10588 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10589 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10590 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010592 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10593 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10594 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010595
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010596 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10597 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010599 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10601 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010603 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010605 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10607 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10609 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10611 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10613 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10614 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10615 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10616 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10617 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010620 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10621 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10622 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10623 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10624 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010626 Example :
10627
10628 # this is a comment and is ignored
10629 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10630 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10631 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10632 | | | `---------- value
10633 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10634 | `---------------------------- key
10635 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10636
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010637mod(<value>)
10638 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10639 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10640
10641mul(<value>)
10642 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10643 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10644 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10645
10646neg
10647 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10648 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10649 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10650 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10651
10652not
10653 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10654 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10655 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10656 absence of a flag).
10657
10658odd
10659 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10660 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10661
10662or(<value>)
10663 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10664 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10665
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010666regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010667 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10668 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10669 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10670 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10671 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10672 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10673 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10674 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10675 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10676 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10677 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10678 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10679 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10680
10681 Example :
10682
10683 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10684 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10685 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10686 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10687
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010688sdbm([<avalanche>])
10689 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10690 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10691 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10692 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10693 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10694 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10695 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010696 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10697 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010699sub(<value>)
10700 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10701 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10702 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10703
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010704table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10705 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10706 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10707 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10708 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10709 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10710 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10711
10712
10713table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10717 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10718 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10719 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10720
10721table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10725 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10726 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10727
10728table_conn_cur(<table>)
10729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10732 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10733 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10734
10735table_conn_rate(<table>)
10736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10739 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10740 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10741
10742table_gpc0(<table>)
10743 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10744 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10745 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10746 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10747 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10748
10749table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10750 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10751 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10752 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10753 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10754 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10755 sample fetch keyword.
10756
10757table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10761 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10762 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10763
10764table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10765 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10766 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10767 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10768 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10769 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10770 keyword.
10771
10772table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10776 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10777 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10778
10779table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10782 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10783 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10784 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10785 keyword.
10786
10787table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10788 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10789 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10790 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10791 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10792 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10793 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10794 keyword.
10795
10796table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10800 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10801 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10802 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10803 keyword.
10804
10805table_server_id(<table>)
10806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10809 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10810 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10811 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10812
10813table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10817 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10818 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10819 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10820 keyword.
10821
10822table_sess_rate(<table>)
10823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10826 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10827 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10828 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10829 keyword.
10830
10831table_trackers(<table>)
10832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10835 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10836 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10837 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10838 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10839 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10840 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10841 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10842
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010843upper
10844 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10845 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10846 type. The result is of type string.
10847
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010848utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10849 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10850 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10851 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10852 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10853 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10854 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10855
10856 Example :
10857
10858 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10859 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10860 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10861
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010862word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10863 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10864 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10865
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010866wt6([<avalanche>])
10867 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10868 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10869 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10870 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10871 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10872 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10873 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010874 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10875 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010876
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010877xor(<value>)
10878 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10879 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10880
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010881
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108827.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883--------------------------------------------
10884
10885A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10886not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10887"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10888The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10889
10890always_false : boolean
10891 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10892 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10893
10894always_true : boolean
10895 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10896 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10897
10898avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010899 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10901 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10902 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10903 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10904 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10905 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10906 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10907 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10908 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10909 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10910 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10911 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10912 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010914be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010915 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10916 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10917 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10918 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10919 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10923 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10924 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10925 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10926 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10927 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010928
10929 Example :
10930 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10931 backend dynamic
10932 mode http
10933 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10934 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010936connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010938 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10940 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010941
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010942 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010943 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010944 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10945
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010946 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10947 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010948
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010949 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010950 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010952 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10953 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010954 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010955 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010956
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010957 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10958 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010960 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010961
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010962date([<offset>]) : integer
10963 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10964 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10965 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10966 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010967 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10968
10969 Example :
10970
10971 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10972 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010973
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010974env(<name>) : string
10975 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10976 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10977 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10978 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10979 certain way.
10980
10981 Examples :
10982 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10983 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10984
10985 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10986 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010988fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10989 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010990 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10991 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10993 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10994 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10995 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10996 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11000 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11001 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11002 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11003 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11004 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11005 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11006 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011007
11008 Example :
11009 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11010 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11011 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11012 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11013 frontend mail
11014 bind :25
11015 mode tcp
11016 maxconn 100
11017 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11018 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11019 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11020 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011021
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011022nbproc : integer
11023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11024 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11025 and debugging purposes.
11026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11029 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11030 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011031 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11032 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11033 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011034
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011035proc : integer
11036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11037 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11038 debugging purposes.
11039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011040queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11042 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11043 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11045 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11046 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11047 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11048 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11049
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011050rand([<range>]) : integer
11051 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11052 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11053 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11054 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11055 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11059 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11060 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11061 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11062 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11063 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11064 methods.
11065
11066srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11067 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11068 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11069 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11070 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11071 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11072 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11073 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11074
11075srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11076 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11077 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011078 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011079 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11080 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11081 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11082 overloading servers).
11083
11084 Example :
11085 # Redirect to a separate back
11086 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11087 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11088 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11089
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011090stopping : boolean
11091 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11092 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11093 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011095table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11096 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11097 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11098
11099table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11100 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11101 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11102 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11103
11104
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111057.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106----------------------------------
11107
11108The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11109closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11110methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11111sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11112TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011113the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11114counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11115"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011116argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11117the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11118this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011119
11120be_id : integer
11121 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11122 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11123
11124dst : ip
11125 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11126 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11127 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11128 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11129 RFC 4291.
11130
11131dst_conn : integer
11132 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11133 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11134 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11135 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11136 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11137 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11138 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11139 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011141dst_port : integer
11142 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11143 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11144 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11145 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11146 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11147 an HTTP header.
11148
11149fe_id : integer
11150 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11151 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11152 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011154sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011155sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11156sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11157sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011158 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11159 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11160 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11161
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011162sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011163sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11164sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11165sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011166 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11167 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11168 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11169
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011170sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011171sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11172sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11173sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011174 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11175 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011176 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11177 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11178 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011179
11180 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11181 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011182 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11183 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11184 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011185 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11186 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11187
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011188sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011189sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11190sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11191sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011192 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11193 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11194
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011195sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011196sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11197sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11198sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011199 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11200 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11201 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11202
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011203sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011204sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11205sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11206sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011207 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11208 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11209 See also src_conn_rate.
11210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011211sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011212sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11213sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11214sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011215 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011216 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011217
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011218sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011219sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11220sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11221sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011222 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11223 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11224 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011225 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11226 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11227 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011228
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011229sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011230sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11231sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11232sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011233 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11234 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11235 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11236
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011237sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011238sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11239sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11240sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011241 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11242 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11243 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11244 src_http_err_rate.
11245
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011246sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011247sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11248sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11249sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011250 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11251 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11252 src_http_req_cnt.
11253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011254sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011255sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11256sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11257sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011258 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11259 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11260 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11261 src_http_req_rate.
11262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011263sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011264sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11265sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11266sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011267 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011268 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11269 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11270 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11271 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011272
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011273 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11274 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11276
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011277sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011278sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11279sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11280sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011281 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11282 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11283 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011285sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011286sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11287sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11288sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011289 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11290 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11291 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011292
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011293sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011294sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11295sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11296sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011297 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11298 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11299 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11300 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011301 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011302 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11303
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011304sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011305sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11306sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11307sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011308 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11309 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11310 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11311 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11312 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011313 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011314
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011315sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011316sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11317sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11318sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011319 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11320 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11321 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11322
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011323sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011324sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11325sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11326sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011327 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11328 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011329 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011330 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11331 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011332 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11333 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11334 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336so_id : integer
11337 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11338 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11339 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341src : ip
11342 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11343 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11344 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11345 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11346 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11347 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11348 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011349
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011350 Example:
11351 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11352 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11355 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11356 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11357 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011358 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11361 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11362 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011363 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011364 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11367 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11368 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11369 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11370 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11371 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11372 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011373
11374 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11375 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11376 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11377 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011378 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011379 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11380 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011382src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011383 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011384 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011385 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011386 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011389 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011390 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11391 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011392 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11395 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11396 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11397 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011398 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011400src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011401 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011403 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011404 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011406src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011407 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011409 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11410 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011411 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11412 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11413 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11416 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11417 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011418 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011419 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11423 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11424 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11425 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11426 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011427 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11430 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11431 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11432 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011433 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11436 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11437 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11438 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011439 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011440 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11443 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11444 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11445 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011446 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011447 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11448 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011449
11450 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011451 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011452 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011454src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011455 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11456 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11457 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11458 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11459 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011461src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011462 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11463 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11464 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11465 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11466 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011468src_port : integer
11469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11470 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11471 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11472 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11475 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011476 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11477 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11478 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011479 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11482 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11483 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11484 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11485 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011486 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11489 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11490 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11491 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11492 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11493 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11494 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11495 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11496 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011497
11498 Example :
11499 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11500 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11501 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11502 listen ssh
11503 bind :22
11504 mode tcp
11505 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011506 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011508 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510srv_id : integer
11511 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11512 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11513 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011514
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011515
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115167.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011519The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11520closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11521when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11522usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011523future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011524
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011525ssl_bc : boolean
11526 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11527 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11528 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11529
11530ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11531 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11532 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11533
11534ssl_bc_cipher : string
11535 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11536 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11537
11538ssl_bc_protocol : string
11539 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11540 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11541
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011542ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011543 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011544 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11545 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011546
11547ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11548 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11549 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11550 if session was reused or not.
11551
11552ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11553 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11554 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011556ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11557 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11558 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11559 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11560 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11561 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011563ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11564 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11565 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11566 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11567 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011568
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011569ssl_c_der : binary
11570 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11571 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11572 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011574ssl_c_err : integer
11575 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11576 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11577 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11578 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11579 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11582 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11583 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11584 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11585 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11586 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11587 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11588 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11589 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011591ssl_c_key_alg : string
11592 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11593 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11594 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011596ssl_c_notafter : string
11597 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11598 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11599 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011601ssl_c_notbefore : string
11602 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11603 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11604 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011606ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11607 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11608 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11609 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11610 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11611 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11612 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11613 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11614 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616ssl_c_serial : binary
11617 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11618 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11619 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011621ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11622 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11623 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11624 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011625 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11626 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11627
11628 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011630ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11631 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11632 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11633 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011635ssl_c_used : boolean
11636 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11637 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639ssl_c_verify : integer
11640 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11641 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11642 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11643 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645ssl_c_version : integer
11646 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11647 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011648
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011649ssl_f_der : binary
11650 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11651 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11652 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011654ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11655 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11656 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11657 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11658 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011659 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011660 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11661 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11662 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664ssl_f_key_alg : string
11665 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11666 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11667 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011669ssl_f_notafter : string
11670 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11671 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11672 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011674ssl_f_notbefore : string
11675 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11676 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11677 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011679ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11680 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11681 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11682 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11683 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11684 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11685 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11686 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11687 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011689ssl_f_serial : binary
11690 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11691 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11692 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011693
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011694ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11695 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11696 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11697 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11700 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11701 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11702 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011704ssl_f_version : integer
11705 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11706 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11707
11708ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011709 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11710 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11711 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713 Example :
11714 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11715 listen http-https
11716 bind :80
11717 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11718 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11719
11720ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11721 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11722 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11723
11724ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011725 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11727 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11728 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11729 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11730 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11731 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11732 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11733 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011735ssl_fc_cipher : string
11736 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11737 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011739ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011740 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11741 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011742 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11743 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11744 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11745 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011747ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11748 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011749 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11750 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11751 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11752 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011755 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11757 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11758 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11759 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11760 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11761 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11762 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011764ssl_fc_protocol : string
11765 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11766 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011767
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011768ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011770 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11771 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011773ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11774 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11775 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11776 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11777 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011779ssl_fc_sni : string
11780 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11781 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11782 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11783 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11784 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11785
11786 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11787 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11788 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011789 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11790 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011793 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11794 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11797 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11798 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011799
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011800
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200118017.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11805sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11806only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11807For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11808be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11809can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11810sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11811for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11812content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11815 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11816 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11817 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011819payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11820 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11821 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11822 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011824req.len : integer
11825req_len : integer (deprecated)
11826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11827 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11828 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11829 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11830 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11831 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11832 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11833 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11836 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011837 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11838 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11839 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11840 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842 ACL alternatives :
11843 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11846 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11847 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11848 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11849 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851 ACL alternatives :
11852 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011854 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856req.proto_http : boolean
11857req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11858 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11859 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11860 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11861 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11862 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11863 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11864 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011866 Example:
11867 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11868 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11869 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011870 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011872req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11873rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11874 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11875 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11876 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11877 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11878 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11879 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11880 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011882 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11883 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11884 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11885 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11886 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11887 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011889 ACL derivatives :
11890 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011892 Example :
11893 listen tse-farm
11894 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11895 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11896 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11897 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11898 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11899 persist rdp-cookie
11900 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11901 # This is only useful makes sense if
11902 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11903 stick-table type string size 204800
11904 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11905 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11906 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011908 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11909 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011911req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11912rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11913 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11914 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11915 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11916 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918 ACL derivatives :
11919 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11922req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11923 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11924 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11925 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11926 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11927 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11928 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11929 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931req.ssl_sni : string
11932req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11933 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11934 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11935 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11936 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11937 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11938 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11939 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11940 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11941 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11942 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11943 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11944 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946 ACL derivatives :
11947 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011949 Examples :
11950 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11951 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11952 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11953 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11954 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11957rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11958 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11959 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11960 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11961 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11962 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11963 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11964 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011966req.ssl_ver : integer
11967req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11968 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11969 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11970 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11971 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11972 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11973 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11974 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11975 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11976 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978 ACL derivatives :
11979 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011980
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011981res.len : integer
11982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11983 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11984 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11985 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11986 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11987 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11988 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11989 content inspection.
11990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011991res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11992 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011993 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11994 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11995 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11996 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011998res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11999 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12000 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12001 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12002 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012004 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012006wait_end : boolean
12007 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12008 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12009 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12010 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12011 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12012 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12013 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12014 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 Examples :
12017 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12018 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12019 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12022 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12023 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12024 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12025 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12026 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12027 tcp-request content reject
12028
12029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120307.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012031--------------------------------------
12032
12033It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12034This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12035data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12036its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12037HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12038content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12039to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12040more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12041response are indexed.
12042
12043base : string
12044 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12045 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12046 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12047 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12048 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12049 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12050 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12051 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12052
12053 ACL derivatives :
12054 base : exact string match
12055 base_beg : prefix match
12056 base_dir : subdir match
12057 base_dom : domain match
12058 base_end : suffix match
12059 base_len : length match
12060 base_reg : regex match
12061 base_sub : substring match
12062
12063base32 : integer
12064 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12065 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12066 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012067 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12068 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12069 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012070
12071base32+src : binary
12072 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12073 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12074 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12075 per-URL counters.
12076
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012077capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12078 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12079 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12080 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12081
12082capture.req.method : string
12083 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12084 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12085 because it's allocated.
12086
12087capture.req.uri : string
12088 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12089 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12090 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12091 allocated.
12092
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012093capture.req.ver : string
12094 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12095 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12096 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12097
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012098capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12099 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12100 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12101 The first entry is an index of 0.
12102 See also: "capture response header"
12103
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012104capture.res.ver : string
12105 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12106 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12107 persistent flag.
12108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012109req.cook([<name>]) : string
12110cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12111 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12112 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12113 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12114 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12115 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12116 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12117 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12118 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12119
12120 ACL derivatives :
12121 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12122 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12123 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12124 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12125 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12126 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12127 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12128 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12131cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12132 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12133 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012135req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12136cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12137 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12138 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12139 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12140 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12143 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12144 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12145 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12146 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12147 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12148 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12149 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12150 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12151 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12152 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012154hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12155 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12156 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12157 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12158 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012159 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12162 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12163 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12164 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12165 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12166 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12167 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12168 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12169 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12172 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12173 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12174 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12175 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12178 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12179 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12180 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12181 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12182 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12183 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12184 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12185 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12186 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12187 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12188 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012190 ACL derivatives :
12191 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12192 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12193 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12194 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12195 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12196 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12197 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12198 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12199
12200req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12201hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12202 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12203 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12204 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12205 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12206 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12207 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12208 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12209 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12210 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12211
12212req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12213hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12214 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12215 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12216 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12217 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12218 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12219 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12220 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12221 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12222
12223req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12224hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12225 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12226 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12227 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12228 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12229 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12230 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12231 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12232
12233http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12234 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12235 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12236 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12237 basic auth is supported.
12238
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012239http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12240 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12241 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12242 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12243 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012244 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12245 basic auth is supported.
12246
12247 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012248 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12249 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12250 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12251 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252
12253http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012254 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12255 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12257 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012259method : integer + string
12260 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12261 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12262 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12263 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12264 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12265 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12266 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268 ACL derivatives :
12269 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271 Example :
12272 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12273 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12274 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276path : string
12277 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12278 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12279 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12280 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12281 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12282 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12283 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012285 ACL derivatives :
12286 path : exact string match
12287 path_beg : prefix match
12288 path_dir : subdir match
12289 path_dom : domain match
12290 path_end : suffix match
12291 path_len : length match
12292 path_reg : regex match
12293 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012294
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012295query : string
12296 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12297 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12298 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12299 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12300 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12301 which stops before the question mark.
12302
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012303req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12304 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12305 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12306 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12307 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012309req.ver : string
12310req_ver : string (deprecated)
12311 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12312 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12313 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012315 ACL derivatives :
12316 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012318res.comp : boolean
12319 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12320 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12321 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012323res.comp_algo : string
12324 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12325 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12326 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328res.cook([<name>]) : string
12329scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12330 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12331 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12332 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012334 ACL derivatives :
12335 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012337res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12338scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12339 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12340 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12341 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012343res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12344scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12345 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12346 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12347 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012349res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12350 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12351 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12352 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12353 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12354 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12355 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12356 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12357 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12358 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12362 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12363 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12364 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12365 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12368shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12369 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12370 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12371 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12372 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12373 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12374 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12375 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12376 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012378 ACL derivatives :
12379 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12380 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12381 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12382 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12383 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12384 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12385 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12386 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12387
12388res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12389shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12390 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12391 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12392 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12393 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12394 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012396res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12397shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12398 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12399 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12400 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12401 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12402 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12403 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012404
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012405res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12406 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12407 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12408 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12409 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012411res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12412shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12413 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12414 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12415 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12416 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12417 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12418 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420res.ver : string
12421resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12422 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12423 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425 ACL derivatives :
12426 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12429 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12430 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12431 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12432 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12435 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012439status : integer
12440 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12441 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12442 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012444url : string
12445 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12446 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12447 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12448 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12449 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12450 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12451 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012453 ACL derivatives :
12454 url : exact string match
12455 url_beg : prefix match
12456 url_dir : subdir match
12457 url_dom : domain match
12458 url_end : suffix match
12459 url_len : length match
12460 url_reg : regex match
12461 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012463url_ip : ip
12464 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12465 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12466 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12467 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12468 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12469 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12470 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012472url_port : integer
12473 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12474 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12475 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12476 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12479url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12480 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12481 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12482 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12483 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12484 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12485 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12486 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12487 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12488 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012490 ACL derivatives :
12491 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12492 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12493 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12494 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12495 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12496 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12497 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12498 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012499
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501 Example :
12502 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12503 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12504 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12505 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12508 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12509 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12510 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012511
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125137.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012514---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012516Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12517every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012518order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012520ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12521---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012522FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012523HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012524HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12525HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012526HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12527HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12528HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12529HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12530LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012531METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12532METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12533METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12534METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12535METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12536METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012537RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012538REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012539TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012540WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12541---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012542
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125448. Logging
12545----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012546
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012547One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12548provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12549very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12550provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12551state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012552to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012553headers.
12554
12555In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12556about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12557send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12558
12559 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12560 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12561 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12562 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12563 at the termination.
12564
12565The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12566allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12567as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12568while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12569real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12570delay.
12571
12572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125738.1. Log levels
12574---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012575
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012576TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012577source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012578HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12579in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12580track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12581syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12582about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012583
12584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125858.2. Log formats
12586----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012588HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012589and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12590slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12591options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012592
12593 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12594 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12595 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12596 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12597 extents.
12598
12599 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12600 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12601 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12602 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12603 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12604
12605 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12606 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12607 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12608 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12609 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12610
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012611 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12612 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12613 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12614 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12615
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012616 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12617
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012618Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12619specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12620field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12621servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12622always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12623identifier.
12624
12625Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12626 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12627 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12628 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12629 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12630
12631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126328.2.1. Default log format
12633-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012634
12635This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12636as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12637format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12638
12639 Example :
12640 listen www
12641 mode http
12642 log global
12643 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12644
12645 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12646 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12647 (www/HTTP)
12648
12649 Field Format Extract from the example above
12650 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12651 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12652 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12653 4 'to' to
12654 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12655 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12656
12657Detailed fields description :
12658 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12659 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12660 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12661 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12662 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12663 and processed the connection.
12664 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12665
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012666In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12667"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12668connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012670It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12671will eventually disappear.
12672
12673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126748.2.2. TCP log format
12675---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012676
12677The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12678is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12679information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12680counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12681emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12682environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12683the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12684sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012685specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12686not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12687fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12688marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012689
12690 Example :
12691 frontend fnt
12692 mode tcp
12693 option tcplog
12694 log global
12695 default_backend bck
12696
12697 backend bck
12698 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12699
12700 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12701 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12702 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12703
12704 Field Format Extract from the example above
12705 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12706 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12707 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12708 4 frontend_name fnt
12709 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12710 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12711 7 bytes_read* 212
12712 8 termination_state --
12713 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12714 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12715
12716Detailed fields description :
12717 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012718 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12719 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12720 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12721 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12722 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012723
12724 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012725 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12726 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12727 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012728
12729 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12730 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12731 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12732 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12733
12734 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12735 and processed the connection.
12736
12737 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12738 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12739 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12740 applications.
12741
12742 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12743 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12744 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12745 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12746 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12747
12748 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12749 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12750 See "Timers" below for more details.
12751
12752 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12753 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12754 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12755 "Timers" below for more details.
12756
12757 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012758 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012759 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12760 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12761 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12762 details.
12763
12764 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12765 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12766 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12767 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12768 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12769
12770 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12771 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12772 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12773 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12774 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12775 for more details.
12776
12777 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012778 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012779 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12780 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12781 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012782 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012783
12784 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12785 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12786 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12787 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12788 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12789 caused by a denial of service attack.
12790
12791 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12792 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12793 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12794 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12795 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12796 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12797 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12798 denial of service attack.
12799
12800 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12801 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12802 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12803 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12804 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12805 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12806 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12807 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12808 be processed than on other servers.
12809
12810 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12811 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12812 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12813 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12814 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12815 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12816 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12817 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12818 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12819 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12820 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12821 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12822 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12823
12824 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12825 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12826 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12827 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12828 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12829 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12830 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12831 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12832
12833 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12834 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12835 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12836 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12837 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12838 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12839 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12840 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12841 occurs.
12842
12843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128448.2.3. HTTP log format
12845----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012846
12847The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12848is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12849the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12850are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12851emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12852generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12853"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12854which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012855frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12856is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012857
12858Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12859slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12860with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12861
12862 Example :
12863 frontend http-in
12864 mode http
12865 option httplog
12866 log global
12867 default_backend bck
12868
12869 backend static
12870 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12871
12872 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12873 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12874 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012875 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012876
12877 Field Format Extract from the example above
12878 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12879 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12880 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12881 4 frontend_name http-in
12882 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12883 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12884 7 status_code 200
12885 8 bytes_read* 2750
12886 9 captured_request_cookie -
12887 10 captured_response_cookie -
12888 11 termination_state ----
12889 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12890 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12891 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12892 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12893 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012894
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012895
12896Detailed fields description :
12897 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012898 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12899 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12900 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12901 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12902 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012903
12904 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012905 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12906 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12907 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012908
12909 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12910 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12911 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12912 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12913 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12914
12915 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12916 and processed the connection.
12917
12918 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12919 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12920 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12921
12922 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12923 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12924 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12925 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12926 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12927 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12928
12929 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12930 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12931 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12932 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12933 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12934 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12935
12936 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12937 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12938 See "Timers" below for more details.
12939
12940 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12941 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12942 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12943 below for more details.
12944
12945 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12946 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12947 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12948 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12949 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12950 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12951 for more details.
12952
12953 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012954 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012955 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12956 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12957 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12958 details.
12959
12960 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12961 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12962 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12963
12964 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12965 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12966 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12967 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12968 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12969 overflowing.
12970
12971 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12972 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12973 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12974 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12975 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12976 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12977 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12978 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12979
12980 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12981 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12982 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12983 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12984 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12985 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12986 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12987 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12988
12989 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12990 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12991 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12992 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12993 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12994 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12995 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12996
12997 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012998 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012999 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13000 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13001 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013002 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013003 system.
13004
13005 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13006 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13007 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13008 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13009 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13010 caused by a denial of service attack.
13011
13012 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13013 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13014 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13015 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13016 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13017 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13018 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13019 denial of service attack.
13020
13021 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13022 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13023 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13024 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13025 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13026 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13027 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13028 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13029 processed than on other servers.
13030
13031 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13032 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13033 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13034 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13035 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13036 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13037 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13038 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13039 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13040 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13041 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13042 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13043 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13044
13045 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13046 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13047 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13048 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13049 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13050 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13051 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13052 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13053
13054 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13055 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13056 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13057 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13058 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13059 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13060 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13061 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13062 occurs.
13063
13064 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13065 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13066 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13067 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13068 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13069 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13070 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13071 cookies" below for more details.
13072
13073 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13074 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13075 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13076 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13077 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13078 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13079 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13080 and cookies" below for more details.
13081
13082 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13083 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13084 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13085 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13086 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13087 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13088 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13089 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13090
13091
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200130928.2.4. Custom log format
13093------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013094
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013095The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013096mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013097
13098HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13099Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13100separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13101prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13102
13103Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13104variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13105string formats ("Q").
13106
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013107If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013108as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013109less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13110the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13111
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013112Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013113In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013114in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013115
13116Flags are :
13117 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013118 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013119
13120 Example:
13121
13122 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13123 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13124
13125At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13126
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013127 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13128 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013129
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013130the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013131
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013132 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013133 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013134 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013135
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013136and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13137
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013138 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013139 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13140
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013141Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13142
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013143 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013144 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013145 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13146 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13147 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013148 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13149 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13150 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013151 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013152 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013153 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013154 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013155 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013156 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013157 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13158 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013159 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013160 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13161 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013162 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013163 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13164 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013165 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13166 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13167 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013168 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013169 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13170 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013171 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013172 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13173 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13174 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013175 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013176 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013177 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13178 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13179 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13180 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013181 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013182 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013183 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013184 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013185 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013186 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013187 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13188 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13189 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013190 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013191 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13192 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013193 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013194 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013195 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013196 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013197
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013198 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013199
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013200
132018.2.5. Error log format
13202-----------------------
13203
13204When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13205protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13206By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13207"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13208will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13209logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13210
13211The format looks like this :
13212
13213 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13214 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13215 Connection error during SSL handshake
13216
13217 Field Format Extract from the example above
13218 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13219 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13220 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13221 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13222 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13223
13224These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13225failures.
13226
13227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132288.3. Advanced logging options
13229-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013230
13231Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13232just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13233options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13234for more information about their usage.
13235
13236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132378.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13238------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013239
13240It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13241haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13242commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13243monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13244ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13245
13246 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13247 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13248 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13249 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13250
13251 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13252 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13253 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013254 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013255 such as other load-balancers.
13256
13257 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13258 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13259 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13260
13261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132628.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13263----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013264
13265The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13266what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13267or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13268"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13269just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13270log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13271after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13272is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13273with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13274with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13275
13276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132778.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13278------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013279
13280Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13281for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13282"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13283retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13284raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13285a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13286file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13287you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13288"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13289
13290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13292--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013293
13294Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13295multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13296them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13297"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13298logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13299error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13300and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13301too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13302useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13303alternative.
13304
13305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133068.4. Timing events
13307------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013308
13309Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13310reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13311the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13312frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13313mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13314
13315 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13316 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13317 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13318 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13319 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13320
13321 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13322 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13323 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13324 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13325 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13326
13327 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13328 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13329 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13330 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13331 connection never established.
13332
13333 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13334 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13335 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13336 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13337 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13338 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13339 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13340 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13341 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13342 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13343 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13344
13345 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13346 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13347 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13348 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013349 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013350
13351 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13352
13353 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13354 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13355 negative.
13356
13357These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13358protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13359that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013360due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013361close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13362session has been aborted on timeout.
13363
13364Most common cases :
13365
13366 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13367 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13368 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13369 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13370 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13371 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13372 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13373 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13374 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013375 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13376 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13377 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013378
13379 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13380 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13381 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13382 of ms on remote networks.
13383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013384 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13385 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13386 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013387
13388 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13389 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13390 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13391 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13392 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13393 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13394 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13395 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13396 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13397 to the server until another one is released.
13398
13399Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13400
13401 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13402 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13403 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13404
13405 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13406 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13407 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13408
13409 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13410 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13411 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13412 flags.
13413
13414 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13415 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13416 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13417 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13418 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13419 the client connection was maintained open.
13420
13421 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013422 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013423 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13424 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13425
13426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134278.5. Session state at disconnection
13428-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013429
13430TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13431"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
134322-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13433each of which has a special meaning :
13434
13435 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13436 session to terminate :
13437
13438 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13439
13440 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13441 server explicitly refused it.
13442
13443 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13444 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13445 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13446 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013447 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13448
13449 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13450 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013451
13452 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13453 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13454 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13455 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13456 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13457
13458 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13459 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13460 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13461 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13462 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13463
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013464 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13465 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13466
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013467 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13468 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13469 backup connections when going up.
13470
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013471 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013473 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13474 send or receive data.
13475
13476 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13477 send or receive data.
13478
13479 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13480 with nothing left in the buffers.
13481
13482 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13483
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013484 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013485 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13486
13487 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13488 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13489 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13490 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13491 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13492
13493 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13494 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13495
13496 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13497 server (HTTP only).
13498
13499 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13500
13501 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13502 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13503 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13504
13505 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13506 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13507 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13508
13509 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13510
13511 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13512 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13513
13514 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13515 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13516 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13517
13518 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13519 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013520 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13521 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013522
13523 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13524 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13525 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13526 another server.
13527
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013528 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013529 server.
13530
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013531 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13532 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13533 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13534 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13535
13536 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13537 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13538 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13539 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13540
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013541 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13542 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13543 "use-server" rule).
13544
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013545 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13546
13547 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13548 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13549
13550 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13551
13552 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13553 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13554 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13555
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013556 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13557 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013558 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013559 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13560 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13561
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013562 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13563
13564 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13565 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13566
13567 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13568
13569 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13570
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013571The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13572was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013573helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13574starvation, attacks, etc...
13575
13576The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13577alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13578easier finding and understanding.
13579
13580 Flags Reason
13581
13582 -- Normal termination.
13583
13584 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13585 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13586 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13587 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13588
13589 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13590 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13591 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13592 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13593 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13594 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013595
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013596 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13597 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013598 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013599
13600 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13601 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13602 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13603
13604 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13605 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13606 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13607 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13608 the server takes too long to respond.
13609
13610 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13611 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13612 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13613 long a time to respond.
13614
13615 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13616 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13617 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13618 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13619 and the client.
13620
13621 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13622 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13623 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13624 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13625 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013626 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13627 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13628 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13629 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13630 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13631 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13632 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13633 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13634 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13635 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13636 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13637 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13638 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13639 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013640
13641 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13642 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013643 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13644 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13645 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13646 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013647
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013648 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13649 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013651 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013652 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13653 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13654 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13655 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13656 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13657
13658 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13659 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13660 503 or 504 here.
13661
13662 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13663 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13664 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13665 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13666 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13667
13668 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13669 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013670 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013671 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13672 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13673
13674 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13675 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13676 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13677 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13678 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13679 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13680 between haproxy and the server.
13681
13682 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13683 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13684 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13685 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13686 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13687 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13688 solution is to fix the application.
13689
13690 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13691 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13692 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13693 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13694 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13695 external attacks.
13696
13697 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13698 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013699 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013700 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13701 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13702
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013703 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13704 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13705 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013706 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13707 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013709 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13710 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13711 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13712 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013713 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13714 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13715 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13716 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13717 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013718
13719 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13720 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13721 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13722 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13723
13724 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13725 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13726 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13727 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13728
13729 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13730 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13731 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13732 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13733
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013734The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13735persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13736important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13737re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13738
13739 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13740
13741 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13742 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13743 set on a GET request.
13744
13745 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13746 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013747 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013748 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13749
13750 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13751 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13752 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13753
13754 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13755 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13756 already got a cookie.
13757
13758 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13759 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13760 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13761 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13762 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13763
13764 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13765 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13766 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13767
13768 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13769 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13770 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13771
13772 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13773 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13774
13775 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13776 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13777 then advertised in the response.
13778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137808.6. Non-printable characters
13781-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013782
13783In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13784consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13785converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13786prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13787being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13788escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13789is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13790'}' when logging headers.
13791
13792Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13793issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13794containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13795
13796Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13797the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13798performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13799
13800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13802---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013803
13804Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13805achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013806section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013807cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13808the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13809the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013810locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013811not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13812user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13813a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13814wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13815
13816 Examples :
13817 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13818 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13819
13820 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13821 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13822
13823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138248.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13825---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013826
13827Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13828proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13829the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13830server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13831
13832Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13833response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013834section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013835
13836It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013837time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13838appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013839are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13840and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13841follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13842request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13843in the logs.
13844
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013845As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13846frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13847an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13848
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013849 Example :
13850 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13851 listen proxy-out
13852 mode http
13853 option httplog
13854 option logasap
13855 log global
13856 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13857
13858 # log the name of the virtual server
13859 capture request header Host len 20
13860
13861 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13862 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13863
13864 # log the beginning of the referrer
13865 capture request header Referer len 20
13866
13867 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13868 capture response header Server len 20
13869
13870 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13871 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13872
13873 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13874 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13875
13876 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13877 capture response header Via len 20
13878
13879 # log the URL location during a redirection
13880 capture response header Location len 20
13881
13882 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13883 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13884 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13885 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13886 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13887
13888 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13889 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13890 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13891 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013892 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013893
13894 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13895 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13896 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13897 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13898 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013899 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013900
13901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139028.9. Examples of logs
13903---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013904
13905These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13906them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13907reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13908
13909 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13910 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13911 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13912
13913 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13914 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13915
13916 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13917 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13918 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13919
13920 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13921 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13922
13923 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13924 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13925 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13926
13927 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013928 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013929 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13930 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13931
13932 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13933 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13934 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13935
13936 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13937 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013938 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013939 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13940 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13941 to return the 502 and not the server.
13942
13943 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013944 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013945
13946 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13947 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13948 Nothing was sent to any server.
13949
13950 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13951 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13952
13953 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13954 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13955 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13956 send a 408 return code to the client.
13957
13958 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13959 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13960
13961 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13962 5 seconds ("c----").
13963
13964 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13965 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013966 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013967
13968 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013969 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013970 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13971 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13972 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13973 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13974 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013975
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139779. Statistics and monitoring
13978----------------------------
13979
13980It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13981mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13982CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13983Unix socket.
13984
13985
139869.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013987---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013988
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013989The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013990page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13991begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13992represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13993use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13994('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13995(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13996text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13997do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13998use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013999
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014000In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14001that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14002S (Servers).
14003
14004 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14005 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14006 any name for server/listener)
14007 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14008 number queued without a server assigned.
14009 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14010 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14011 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14012 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14013 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14014 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14015 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14016 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14017 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14018 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14019 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14020 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14021 "option checkcache".
14022 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14023 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14024 - read error from the client
14025 - client timeout
14026 - client closed connection
14027 - various bad requests from the client.
14028 - request was tarpitted.
14029 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14030 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14031 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14032 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14033 active servers).
14034 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14035 Some other errors are:
14036 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14037 - failure applying filters to the response.
14038 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14039 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14040 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14041 switched away from.
14042 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14043 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14044 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14045 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14046 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14047 the server is up.)
14048 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14049 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14050 counters for each server.
14051 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14052 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14053 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14054 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14055 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14056 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14057 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14058 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14059 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14060 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14061 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14062 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14063 of times that server was selected.
14064 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14065 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14066 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14067 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14068 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14069 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014070 UNK -> unknown
14071 INI -> initializing
14072 SOCKERR -> socket error
14073 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
14074 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
14075 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14076 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14077 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14078 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14079 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14080 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14081 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14082 disable-on-404
14083 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14084 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14085 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014086 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14087 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14088 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14089 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14090 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14091 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14092 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14093 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14094 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14095 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14096 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14097 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14098 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14099 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14100 (inc. in eresp)
14101 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14102 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14103 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14104 (CPU/BW limit)
14105 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14106 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14107 server/backend
14108 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14109 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14110 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14111 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14112 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14113 (0 for TCP)
14114 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14115 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014116
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141189.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014119-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014120
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014121The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14122necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14123A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14124issuing commands by hand :
14125
14126 global
14127 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14128 stats timeout 2m
14129
14130It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14131the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14132never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14133situations :
14134
14135 global
14136 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14137 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14138 stats timeout 2m
14139
14140To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14141swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14142to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14143syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14144
14145 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14146 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14147
14148The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14149script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14150for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14151
14152The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14153that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14154editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14155(eg: watch a counter).
14156
14157The socket supports two operation modes :
14158 - interactive
14159 - non-interactive
14160
14161The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14162this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14163sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14164mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14165commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14166example :
14167
14168 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14169
14170The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14171entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14172for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14173sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14174"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14175after processing the last command of the same line.
14176
14177For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14178"prompt" command :
14179
14180 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14181 prompt
14182 > show info
14183 ...
14184 >
14185
14186Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14187delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14188that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14189parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014190
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014191It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14192on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14193own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014194
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014195The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14196If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14197all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14198it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14199
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014200add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014201 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14202 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14203 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14204 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014205
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014206add map <map> <key> <value>
14207 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14208 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014209 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14210 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14211 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014213clear counters
14214 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14215 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14216 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14217 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14218 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14219
14220clear counters all
14221 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14222 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14223 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14224
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014225clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014226 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14227 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14228 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014229
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014230clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014231 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14232 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14233 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014234
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014235clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14236 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14237
14238 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14239 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14240 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14241 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14242 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14243 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14244
14245 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14246
14247 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14248 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14249 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14250 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14251 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14252 the ACLs :
14253
14254 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14255 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14256 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14257 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14258 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14259 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14260
14261 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014262 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14263 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014264
14265 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014266 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014267 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014268 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14269 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14270 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14271 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014272
14273 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14274
14275 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014276 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014277 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14278 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014279 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14280 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14281 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014282
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014283del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14284 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014285 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14286 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14287 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14288 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014289
14290del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014291 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014292 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14293 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14294 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14295 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014296
14297disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014298 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14299
14300 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14301 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14302 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14303 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14304 re-enabled using enable agent.
14305
14306 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14307 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14308 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14309 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14310 otherwise unchanged.
14311
14312 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14313 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14314 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14315
14316 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14317 level "admin".
14318
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014319disable frontend <frontend>
14320 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14321 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14322 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14323 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14324 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14325 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14326 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14327 on the stats page.
14328
14329 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14330 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14331
14332 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14333 level "admin".
14334
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014335disable health <backend>/<server>
14336 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14337 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14338 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14339 agent check forces it down.
14340
14341 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14342 level "admin".
14343
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014344disable server <backend>/<server>
14345 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14346 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14347 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14348 during the maintenance.
14349
14350 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14351 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14352
14353 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014354 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014355
14356 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14357 level "admin".
14358
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014359enable agent <backend>/<server>
14360 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14361
14362 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14363 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14364
14365 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14366 level "admin".
14367
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014368enable frontend <frontend>
14369 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14370 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14371 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14372 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14373 which was disabled.
14374
14375 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14376 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14377
14378 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14379 level "admin".
14380
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014381enable health <backend>/<server>
14382 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14383 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14384
14385 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14386 level "admin".
14387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014388enable server <backend>/<server>
14389 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14390 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14391
14392 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014393 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014394
14395 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14396 level "admin".
14397
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014398get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014399get acl <acl> <value>
14400 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14401 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14402 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14403 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14404 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014405
14406 The first two words are:
14407
14408 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14409 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14410 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14411
14412 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14413
14414 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14415
14416 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14417
14418 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14419 interpretation of the case.
14420
14421 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14422 useful with regular expressions.
14423
14424 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14425 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14426
14427 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14428 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14429 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14430
14431 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14432
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014433get weight <backend>/<server>
14434 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14435 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14436 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14437 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14438 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014439 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014440
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014441help
14442 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14443 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014444
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014445prompt
14446 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14447 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14448 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14449 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14450 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14451 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14452 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14453 command.
14454
14455quit
14456 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014457
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014458set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014459 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14460 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14461 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014462
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014463set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014464 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14465 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14466 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14467 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14468 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014469 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14470 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14471
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014472set maxconn global <maxconn>
14473 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14474 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14475 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14476 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14477 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14478 setting.
14479
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014480set rate-limit connections global <value>
14481 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14482 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14483 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14484 is passed in number of connections per second.
14485
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014486set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14487 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14488 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014489 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14490 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014491
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014492set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14493 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14494 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14495 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14496 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14497
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014498set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14499 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14500 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14501 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14502 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14503 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14504
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014505set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14506 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14507 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14508 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14509
14510set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14511 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14512 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14513 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14514
14515set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14516 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14517 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14518 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14519 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14520 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14521 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14522 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14523 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14524
14525set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14526 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14527 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14528
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014529set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14530 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14531 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14532 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14533 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14534
14535 Example:
14536 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14537 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14538 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14539 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14540
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014541set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014542 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14543 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14544 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14545 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014546 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14547 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014548
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014549set timeout cli <delay>
14550 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14551 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14552 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14553
14554set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14555 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14556 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014557 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14558 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14559 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14560 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14561 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14562 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14563 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14564 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14565 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14566 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14567 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14568 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14569 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014570
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014571show errors [<iid>]
14572 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14573 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014574 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14575 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14576 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014577
14578 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14579 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14580 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14581 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14582 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14583 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14584 are reported too.
14585
14586 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14587 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14588 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14589 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14590 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14591 code.
14592
14593 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14594 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14595 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14596 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14597 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14598 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14599 line.
14600
14601 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014602 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14603 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014604 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14605 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14606
14607 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14608 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14609 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14610 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14611 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14612 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14613 00204+ minal\r\n
14614 00211 \r\n
14615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014616 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014617 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14618 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14619 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14620 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14621 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14622 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014623
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014624show info
14625 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14626
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014627show map [<map>]
14628 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014629 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14630 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14631 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14632 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14633 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14634 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014635
14636show acl [<acl>]
14637 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014638 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14639 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14640 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14641 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14642 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014643
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014644show pools
14645 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14646 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14647 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14648 the pools.
14649
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014650show sess
14651 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014652 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14653 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14654
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014655show sess <id>
14656 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14657 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14658 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14659 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14660 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014661 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14662 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14663
14664 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14665 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014666
14667show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14668 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14669 possible to dump only selected items :
14670 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14671 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14672 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14673 for example:
14674 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14675 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14676 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14677
14678 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014679 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14680 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014681 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14682 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14683 Nbproc: 1
14684 Process_num: 1
14685 (...)
14686
14687 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14688 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14689 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14690 (...)
14691 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14692
14693 $
14694
14695 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14696 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14697 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14698 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014699 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014700
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014701show table
14702 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14703 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14704 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14705 entries currently in use.
14706
14707 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014708 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014709 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14710 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014711
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014712show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014713 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14714 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14715 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014716 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14717
14718 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14719 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14720 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14721 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14722 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14723
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014724 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14725 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14726 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14727 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14728 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14729 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14730
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014731
14732 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014733 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14734 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014735
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014736 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014737 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014738 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014739 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14740 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14741 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14742 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014743
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014744 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014745 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014746 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14747 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014748
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014749 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14750 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014751 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014752 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14753 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014754
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014755 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14756 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014757 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014758 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14759 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14760
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014761 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14762 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14763 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14764 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14765 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14766
14767 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14768 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14769 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014770 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14771 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014772 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14773 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014774
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014775shutdown frontend <frontend>
14776 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14777 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14778 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14779 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14780 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14781 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14782 once it is terminated.
14783
14784 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14785 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14786
14787 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14788 level "admin".
14789
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014790shutdown session <id>
14791 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14792 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14793 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14794 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14795 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14796 flag in the logs.
14797
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014798shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014799 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14800 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14801 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14802 'K' flag in the logs.
14803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014804/*
14805 * Local variables:
14806 * fill-column: 79
14807 * End:
14808 */